]> gcc.gnu.org Git - gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi
target.def (addr_space): Add new diagnose_usage to hook vector.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56 * Misc:: Everything else.
57 @end menu
58
59 @node Target Structure
60 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61 @cindex target hooks
62 @cindex target functions
63
64 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72 @smallexample
73 #include "target.h"
74 #include "target-def.h"
75
76 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
78 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82 @end smallexample
83 @end deftypevar
84
85 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89 @code{targetm} structure.
90
91 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107 default definition is used.
108
109 @node Driver
110 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111 @cindex driver
112 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
115 You can control the compilation driver.
116
117 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130 that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133 @end defmac
134
135 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145 everywhere it occurs.
146
147 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152 @end defmac
153
154 @defmac CPP_SPEC
155 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160 @end defmac
161
162 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166 @end defmac
167
168 @defmac CC1_SPEC
169 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171 front ends.
172 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173 for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176 @end defmac
177
178 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
181 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187 @end defmac
188
189 @defmac ASM_SPEC
190 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
192 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202 an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218 @end defmac
219
220 @defmac LINK_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
223 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226 @end defmac
227
228 @defmac LIB_SPEC
229 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231 command given to the linker.
232
233 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245 @end defmac
246
247 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
253 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
262 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380 The default value of this macro is empty string.
381 @end defmac
382
383 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
384 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
389 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
391 @end defmac
392
393 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395 @end deftypevr
396
397 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
398 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406 @xref{Target Fragment}.
407 @end defmac
408
409 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
410 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
411 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
412 indicates an absolute file name.
413 @end defmac
414
415 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
416 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
418 when the compiler is built as a cross
419 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
420 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
421 @end defmac
422
423 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
424 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
425 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
426 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
427 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428 is built as a cross compiler.
429 @end defmac
430
431 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436 is built as a cross compiler.
437 @end defmac
438
439 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444 is built as a cross compiler.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
448 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
450 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451 @end defmac
452
453 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
454 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
455 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456 cross compiler.
457 @end defmac
458
459 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
460 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
461 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463 initialize the necessary environment variables.
464 @end defmac
465
466 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
467 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
470 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
472
473 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474 replacement.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
479 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
481 @end defmac
482
483 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
484 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
485 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
487 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
489 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
490 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
491 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
494 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
495 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496 for C++-only directories,
497 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499 the array with a null element.
500
501 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
502 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
503 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
504 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
506 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
507
508 @smallexample
509 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510 @{ \
511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
516 @}
517 @end smallexample
518 @end defmac
519
520 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522 @enumerate
523 @item
524 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
525
526 @item
527 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
528 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
529 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
530
531 @item
532 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534 @item
535 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
536 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544 @item
545 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
546 compiler.
547 @end enumerate
548
549 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551 @enumerate
552 @item
553 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
554
555 @item
556 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557 value based on the installed toolchain location.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
561 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
562
563 @item
564 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
565 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
572 compiler.
573
574 @item
575 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
576 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
580 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/lib/}.
591
592 @item
593 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
595 @file{/usr/lib/}.
596 @end enumerate
597
598 @node Run-time Target
599 @section Run-time Target Specification
600 @cindex run-time target specification
601 @cindex predefined macros
602 @cindex target specifications
603
604 @c prevent bad page break with this line
605 Here are run-time target specifications.
606
607 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
608 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
609 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
610 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
611 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
612 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613 finished command line option processing your code can use those
614 results freely.
615
616 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
618 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
619 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
621 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
622 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
623 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
624 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
632 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
637 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
638 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640 preprocessing.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target operating system instead.
646 @end defmac
647
648 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
649 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652 it yourself.
653 @end defmac
654
655 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
656 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657 any target-specific headers.
658 @end deftypevar
659
660 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
661 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662 Its default setting is 0.
663 @end deftypevr
664
665 @cindex optional hardware or system features
666 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
668 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
669 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673 definition does nothing but return true.
674
675 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679 via attributes).
680 @end deftypefn
681
682 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
683 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
687 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688 default definition does nothing but return false.
689
690 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694 @end deftypefn
695
696 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
697 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698 @end deftypefn
699
700 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702 @end deftypefn
703
704 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706 @end deftypefn
707
708 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
709 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710 @end deftypefn
711
712 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
713 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
714 @end deftypefn
715
716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
717 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
718 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
721 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
723 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724 @end deftypefn
725
726 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
727 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728 but is only used in the C
729 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731 frontends.
732 @end defmac
733
734 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
735 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
736 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738 options are processed once
739 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
740 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
741 options passed explicitly.
742
743 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
744 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745 @code{optimize} attribute.
746 @end deftypevr
747
748 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
749 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
753 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754 @end deftypefn
755
756 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772 is 0.
773 @end defmac
774
775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777 @end deftypefn
778
779 @node Per-Function Data
780 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781 @cindex per-function data
782 @cindex data structures
783
784 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788 when another one comes along.
789
790 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794 to their own specific data.
795
796 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
797 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
800
801 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804 function, for level 0.
805
806 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
807 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
811 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
812 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814 longer supported.
815
816 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
817 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
818 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
819 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
820 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821 @end defmac
822
823 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
829
830 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
831 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
832 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
833 @end deftypevar
834
835 @node Storage Layout
836 @section Storage Layout
837 @cindex storage layout
838
839 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842 @xref{Run-time Target}.
843
844 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
845 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850 macro need not be a constant.
851
852 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
857 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
864 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
866 macro need not be a constant.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873 the order of words in memory.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
877 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883 multi-word integers.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
906 @end defmac
907
908 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
909 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
913 @end defmac
914
915 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
925 @end defmac
926
927 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931 scalar type.
932
933 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938 counterparts.
939
940 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
948 @end defmac
949
950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
951 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
952 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
953 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
954 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
955 pointer} types.
956
957 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
958 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
959 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
960 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
961 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
962 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
963 the signedness may be different.
964
965 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
966
967 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
968 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
969 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
970 @end deftypefn
971
972 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
973 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
974 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
975 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
976 size of an integer.
977 @end defmac
978
979 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
980 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
981 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
982 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
983 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
984 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
985 @end defmac
986
987 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
988 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
989 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
990 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
991 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
992 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
993 @end defmac
994
995 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
996 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
997 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
998 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
999 @end defmac
1000
1001 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1002 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1003 @end defmac
1004
1005 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1006 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1007 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1008 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1009 @end defmac
1010
1011 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1012 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1013 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1014 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1015 @end deftypevr
1016
1017 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1018 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1019 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1020 @end defmac
1021
1022 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1023 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1024 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1025 @end defmac
1026
1027 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1028 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1029 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1030 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1031 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1032 @end defmac
1033
1034 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1035 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1036 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1037 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1038 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1039 @end defmac
1040
1041 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1042 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1043 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1044 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1045 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1046 field alignment has not been set by the
1047 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1048 @end defmac
1049
1050 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1051 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1052 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1053
1054 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1055
1056 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1057 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1058 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1059 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1060 @end defmac
1061
1062 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1063 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1064 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1065 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1066 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1067
1068 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1069 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1070 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1071 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1072 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1073 @end defmac
1074
1075 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1076 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1077 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1078 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1079 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1080
1081 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1082
1083 @findex strcpy
1084 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1085 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1086 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1087 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1088 @end defmac
1089
1090 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1091 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1092 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1093 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1094 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1095
1096 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1097 @end defmac
1098
1099 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1100 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1101 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1102 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1103 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1104 align the object.
1105
1106 The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
1107
1108 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1109 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1110 constants can be done inline.
1111 @end defmac
1112
1113 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1114 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1115 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1116 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1117 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1118
1119 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1120
1121 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1123
1124 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1125 @end defmac
1126
1127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1128 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1129 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1130 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1131 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1132 the vector element type.
1133 @end deftypefn
1134
1135 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1136 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1137 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1138 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1139 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1140 align the slot.
1141
1142 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1143 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1144 be used.
1145
1146 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1147 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1148
1149 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1150 @end defmac
1151
1152 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1153 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1154 variable @var{decl}.
1155
1156 If this macro is not defined, then
1157 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1158 is used.
1159
1160 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1161 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1162
1163 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1164 @end defmac
1165
1166 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1167 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1168 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1169 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1170
1171 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1172 @end defmac
1173
1174 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1175 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1176 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1177
1178 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1179 @end defmac
1180
1181 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1182 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1183 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1184
1185 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1186 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1187 @end defmac
1188
1189 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1190 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1191 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1192 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1193 @end defmac
1194
1195 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1196 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1197 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1198
1199 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1200 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1201 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1202 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1203 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1204
1205 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1206 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1207 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1208 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1209
1210 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1211 structure.
1212
1213 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1214 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1215
1216 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1217 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1218 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1219 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1220
1221 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1222 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1223 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1224
1225 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1226 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1227 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1228
1229 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1230 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1231 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1232
1233 @smallexample
1234 struct foo1
1235 @{
1236 char x;
1237 char :0;
1238 char y;
1239 @};
1240
1241 struct foo2
1242 @{
1243 char x;
1244 int :0;
1245 char y;
1246 @};
1247
1248 main ()
1249 @{
1250 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1251 sizeof (struct foo1));
1252 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1253 sizeof (struct foo2));
1254 exit (0);
1255 @}
1256 @end smallexample
1257
1258 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1259 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1260 @end defmac
1261
1262 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1263 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1264 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1265 @end defmac
1266
1267 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1268 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1269 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1270 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1271 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1272 @end deftypefn
1273
1274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1275 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1276 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1277 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1278
1279 The default is @code{false}.
1280 @end deftypefn
1281
1282 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1283 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1284 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1285
1286 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1287 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1288 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1289 retain the field's mode.
1290
1291 Normally, this is not needed.
1292 @end deftypefn
1293
1294 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1295 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1296 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1297 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1298 @var{specified}.
1299
1300 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1301 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1302 @end defmac
1303
1304 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1305 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1306 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1307 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1308 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1309 (DImode)} is assumed.
1310 @end defmac
1311
1312 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1313 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1314 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1315 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1316 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1317 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1318 having its mode specified.
1319
1320 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1321 would most commonly define this macro if the
1322 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1323 64-bit mode.
1324 @end defmac
1325
1326 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1327 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1328 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1329 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1330
1331 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1332 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1333 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1334 @end defmac
1335
1336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1337 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1338 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1339 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1340 targets.
1341 @end deftypefn
1342
1343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1344 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1345 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1346 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1347 targets.
1348 @end deftypefn
1349
1350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1351 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1352 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1353 @end deftypefn
1354
1355 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1356 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1357 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1358 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1359 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1360 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1361 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1362 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1363 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1364 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1365 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1366 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1367
1368 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1369 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1370 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1371 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1372 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1373 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1374 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1375
1376 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1377 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1378 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1379 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1380 may affect its placement.
1381 @end deftypefn
1382
1383 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1384 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1392 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1393 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1394 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1395 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1396 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1397 usage.
1398 @end deftypefn
1399
1400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1401 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1402 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1403 @end deftypefn
1404
1405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1406 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1407 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1408 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1409 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1410 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1411 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1412 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1413 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1414 string constant.
1415
1416 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1417 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1418 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1419 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1420 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1421 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1422 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1423 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1424 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1425 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1426 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1427 spaces in your string.
1428
1429 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1430 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1431 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1432 before mangling.
1433
1434 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1435 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1436 types.
1437 @end deftypefn
1438
1439 @node Type Layout
1440 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1441
1442 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1443 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1444 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1445 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1446
1447 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1448 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1449 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1450 @end defmac
1451
1452 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1453 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1454 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1455 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1456 unit.)
1457 @end defmac
1458
1459 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1460 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1461 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462 @end defmac
1463
1464 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1465 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1466 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1467 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1468 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1469 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1470 @end defmac
1471
1472 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1473 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1474 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1475 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1476 macro must be at least 64.
1477 @end defmac
1478
1479 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1480 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1481 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1482 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1483 @end defmac
1484
1485 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1486 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1487 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1488 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1493 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1494 @end defmac
1495
1496 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1497 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1498 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1499 words.
1500 @end defmac
1501
1502 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1503 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1504 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1505 words.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1510 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1546 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1548 @end defmac
1549
1550 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1552 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1557 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1558 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1559 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1560 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1561 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1562 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1563 @end defmac
1564
1565 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1566 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1567 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1568 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1569 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1570 @end defmac
1571
1572 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1573 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1574 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1575 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1576 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1577 is the default.
1578 @end defmac
1579
1580 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1581 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1582 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1583 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1584 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1585 @end defmac
1586
1587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1588 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1589 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1590 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1591 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1592
1593 The default is to return false.
1594 @end deftypefn
1595
1596 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1597 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1598 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1599 contents of the string.
1600
1601 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1602 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1603 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1604 of the data type names defined in the function
1605 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1606 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1607 compiler to crash on startup.
1608
1609 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1610 int"}.
1611 @end defmac
1612
1613 @defmac SIZETYPE
1614 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1615 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1616 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1617 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1618 is extracted.
1619
1620 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1621
1622 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1623 @end defmac
1624
1625 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1626 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1627 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1628 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1629 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1630
1631 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1632 @end defmac
1633
1634 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1635 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1636 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1637 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1638 information.
1639
1640 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1641 @end defmac
1642
1643 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1644 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1645 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1646 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1647 @end defmac
1648
1649 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1650 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1651 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1652 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1653 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1654 information.
1655
1656 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1657 @end defmac
1658
1659 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1660 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1661 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1662 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1663 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1664
1665 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1666 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1667 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1668 @end defmac
1669
1670 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1671 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1672 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1673 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1674 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1675
1676 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1677 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1678 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1679 int}.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1683 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1684 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1685 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1686 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1687 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1688 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1689 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1690 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1691 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1692 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1693 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1694 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1695 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1696 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1697 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1698 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1699 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1700 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1701 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1702 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1704 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1705 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1706 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1707 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1709 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1710 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1711 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1712 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1713 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1714 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1715 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1716 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1717 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1718 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1719
1720 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1721 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1722 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1723 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1724 these macros are null pointers.
1725 @end defmac
1726
1727 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1728 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1729 that looks like:
1730
1731 @smallexample
1732 struct @{
1733 union @{
1734 void (*fn)();
1735 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1736 @};
1737 ptrdiff_t delta;
1738 @};
1739 @end smallexample
1740
1741 @noindent
1742 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1743 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1744 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1745 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1746 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1747 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1748 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1749 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1750
1751 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1752 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1753 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1754 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1755 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1756 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1757 architecture, you should define this macro to
1758 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1759
1760 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1761 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1762 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1763 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1764 @end defmac
1765
1766 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1767 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1768 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1769 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1770 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1771 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1772 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1773
1774 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1775 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1776 @end defmac
1777
1778 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1779 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1780 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1781 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1782 when special alignment is necessary. */
1783 @end defmac
1784
1785 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1786 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1787 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1788 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1789 of words in each data entry.
1790 @end defmac
1791
1792 @node Registers
1793 @section Register Usage
1794 @cindex register usage
1795
1796 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1797 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1798
1799 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1800 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1801 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1802 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1803 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1804
1805 @menu
1806 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1807 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1808 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1809 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1810 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1811 @end menu
1812
1813 @node Register Basics
1814 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1815
1816 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1817 Registers have various characteristics.
1818
1819 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1820 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1821 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1822 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1823 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1824 @end defmac
1825
1826 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1827 @cindex fixed register
1828 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1829 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1830 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1831 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1832 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1833 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1834 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1835
1836 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1837 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1838 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1839
1840 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1841 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1842 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1843 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1844 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1845 @end defmac
1846
1847 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1848 @cindex call-used register
1849 @cindex call-clobbered register
1850 @cindex call-saved register
1851 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1852 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1853 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1854 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1855 function calls.
1856
1857 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1858 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1859 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1860 @end defmac
1861
1862 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1863 @cindex call-used register
1864 @cindex call-clobbered register
1865 @cindex call-saved register
1866 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1867 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1868 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1869 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1870 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1871 @end defmac
1872
1873 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1874 @cindex call-used register
1875 @cindex call-clobbered register
1876 @cindex call-saved register
1877 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1878 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1879 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1880 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1881 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1882 @end defmac
1883
1884 @findex fixed_regs
1885 @findex call_used_regs
1886 @findex global_regs
1887 @findex reg_names
1888 @findex reg_class_contents
1889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1890 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1891 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1892 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1893 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1894 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1895 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1896 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1897 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1898 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1899 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1900 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1901 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1902 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1903 command options have been applied.
1904
1905 @cindex disabling certain registers
1906 @cindex controlling register usage
1907 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1908 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1909 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1910 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1911 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1912 that shouldn't be used.
1913
1914 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1915 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1916 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1917 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1918 @end deftypefn
1919
1920 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1921 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1922 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1923 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1924 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1925 outbound register.
1926 @end defmac
1927
1928 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1929 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1930 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1931 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1932 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1933 register.
1934 @end defmac
1935
1936 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1937 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1938 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1939 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1940 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1941 gotos.
1942 @end defmac
1943
1944 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1945 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1946 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1947 @end defmac
1948
1949 @node Allocation Order
1950 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1951 @cindex order of register allocation
1952 @cindex register allocation order
1953
1954 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1955 Registers are allocated in order.
1956
1957 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1958 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1959 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1960 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1961
1962 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1963 (all else being equal).
1964
1965 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1966 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1967 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1968 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1969 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1970 @end defmac
1971
1972 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1974 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1975
1976 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1977 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1978 register; and so on.
1979
1980 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1981 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1982
1983 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1984 @end defmac
1985
1986 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1987 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1988 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1989 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1990 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1991 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1992 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
1993 @end defmac
1994
1995 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1996 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1997 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1998 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1999 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2000 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2001 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2002 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2003
2004 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005 @end defmac
2006
2007 @node Values in Registers
2008 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2009
2010 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2011 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2012 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2013
2014 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2015 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2016 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2017 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2018 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2019 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2020
2021 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2022 definition of this macro is
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2026 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2027 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2028 @end smallexample
2029 @end defmac
2030
2031 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2033 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2034 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2035 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2036 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2037 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2038
2039 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2040 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2041 nonzero.
2042
2043 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2044 @code{subreg_get_info}
2045 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2046 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2047 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2048 registers and so not be representable.
2049 @end defmac
2050
2051 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2052 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2053 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2054 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2055 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2056 @end defmac
2057
2058 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2059 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2060 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2061 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2062 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2063 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2064 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2065 @end defmac
2066
2067 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2068 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2069 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2070 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2071 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2075 @end smallexample
2076
2077 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2078 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2079
2080 @cindex register pairs
2081 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2082 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2083 odd register numbers for such modes.
2084
2085 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2086 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2087 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2088 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2089
2090 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2091 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2092 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2093 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2094 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2095 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2096 to be tieable.
2097
2098 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2099 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2100 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2101 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2102 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2103 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2104
2105 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2106 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2107 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2108 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2109 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2110 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2111 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2112 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2113 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2114
2115 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2116 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2117 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2118 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2119 constraints for those instructions.
2120
2121 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2122 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2123 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2124 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2125 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2126 @end defmac
2127
2128 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2129 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2130 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2131
2132 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2133 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2134 handler.
2135
2136 The default is always nonzero.
2137 @end defmac
2138
2139 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2140 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2141 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2142
2143 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2144 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2145 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2146 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2147 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2148 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2149
2150 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2151 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2152 allocation.
2153 @end defmac
2154
2155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2156 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2157 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2158
2159 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2160 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2161
2162 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2163 @end deftypefn
2164
2165 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2166 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2167 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2168 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2169 @end defmac
2170
2171 @node Leaf Functions
2172 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2173
2174 @cindex leaf functions
2175 @cindex functions, leaf
2176 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2177 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2178 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2179 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2180 normally arrive.
2181
2182 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2183 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2184 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2185 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2186 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2187 functions''.
2188
2189 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2190 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2191 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2192 accomplish this.
2193
2194 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2195 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2196 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2197 function treatment.
2198
2199 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2200 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2201 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2202 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2203 in this vector.
2204
2205 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2206 the treatment of leaf functions.
2207 @end defmac
2208
2209 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2210 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2211 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2212
2213 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2214 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2215 will cause the compiler to abort.
2216
2217 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2218 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2219 this.
2220 @end defmac
2221
2222 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2223 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2224 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2225 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2226 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2227 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2228 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2229 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2230 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2231 functions which only use leaf registers.
2232 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2233 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2234 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2235 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2236 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2237
2238 @node Stack Registers
2239 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2240
2241 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2242 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2243 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2244 stack.
2245
2246 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2247 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2248 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2249 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2250 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2251 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2252 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2253
2254 @defmac STACK_REGS
2255 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2259 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2260 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2261 @end defmac
2262
2263 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2264 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2265 of the stack.
2266 @end defmac
2267
2268 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2269 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2270 the stack.
2271 @end defmac
2272
2273 @node Register Classes
2274 @section Register Classes
2275 @cindex register class definitions
2276 @cindex class definitions, register
2277
2278 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2279 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2280 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2281 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2282
2283 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2284 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2285 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2286
2287 @findex ALL_REGS
2288 @findex NO_REGS
2289 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2290 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2291 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2292 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2293
2294 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2295 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2296 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2297 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2298 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2299 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2300
2301 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2302 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2303
2304 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2305 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2306 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2307 them in operand constraints.
2308
2309 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2310 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2311 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2312 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2313 (@pxref{Costs}).
2314
2315 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2316 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2317 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2318 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2319 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2320 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2321 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2322
2323 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2324 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2325 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2326 in their union.
2327
2328 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2329 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2330 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2331 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2332 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2333
2334 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2335 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2336 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2337 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2338 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2339 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2340 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2341 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2342 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2343
2344 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2345 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2346 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2347 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2348 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2349 tells how many classes there are.
2350
2351 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2352 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2353 in many of the tables described below.
2354 @end deftp
2355
2356 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2357 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2358
2359 @smallexample
2360 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2361 @end smallexample
2362 @end defmac
2363
2364 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2365 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2366 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2367 @end defmac
2368
2369 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2370 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2371 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2372 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2373 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2374
2375 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2376 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2377 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2378 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2379 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2380 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2381 so on.
2382 @end defmac
2383
2384 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2385 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2386 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2387 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2388 register.
2389 @end defmac
2390
2391 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2392 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2393 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2394 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2395 @end defmac
2396
2397 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2398 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2399 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2400 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2401 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2402 @end defmac
2403
2404 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2405 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2406 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2407 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2408 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2409 @end defmac
2410
2411 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2412 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2413 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2414 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2415 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2416 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2417 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2418 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2419 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2420 @end defmac
2421
2422 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2423 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2424 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2425 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2426 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2427 @end defmac
2428
2429 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2430 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2431 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2432 @end defmac
2433
2434 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2435 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2436 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2437 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2438 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2439 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2440 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2441 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2442 @code{address_operand}.
2443 @end defmac
2444
2445 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2446 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2447 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2448 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2449 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2450 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2451 than other base register uses.
2452
2453 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2454 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2455 @end defmac
2456
2457 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2458 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2459 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2460 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2461 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2462 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2463 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2464 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2465 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2466 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2467 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2468 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2469 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2470 @end defmac
2471
2472 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2473 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2474 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2475 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2476 allocated such a hard register.
2477
2478 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2479 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2480 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2481 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2482 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2483 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2484 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2485 only if neither labeling works.
2486 @end defmac
2487
2488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2489 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2490 @end deftypefn
2491
2492 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2493 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2494 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2495 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2496 another, smaller class.
2497
2498 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2499
2500 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2501 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2502 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2503 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2504 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2505
2506 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2507 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2508 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2509 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2510 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2511 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2512 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2513 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2514 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2515 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2516 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2517
2518 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2519 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2520 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2521 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2522 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2523 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2524 @end deftypefn
2525
2526 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2527 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2528 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2529 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2530 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2531 safe:
2532
2533 @smallexample
2534 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2535 @end smallexample
2536
2537 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2538 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2539 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2540 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2541 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2542
2543 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2544 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2545 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2546 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2547 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2548 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2549 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2550 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2551 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2552 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2553 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2554
2555 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2556 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2557 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2558 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2559 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2560 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2561 @end defmac
2562
2563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2564 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2565 input reloads.
2566
2567 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2568 argument.
2569
2570 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2571 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2572 @end deftypefn
2573
2574 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2575 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2576 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2577 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2578 ordinarily be used.
2579
2580 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2581 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2582
2583 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2584 smaller class.
2585
2586 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2587 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2588 @end defmac
2589
2590 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2591 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2592 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2593 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2594 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2595 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2596 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2597 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2598 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2599 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2600 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2601 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2602 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2603
2604 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2605 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2606 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2607 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2608 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2609 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2610 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2611 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2612 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2613 of the scratch register(s).
2614
2615 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2616
2617 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2618 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2619 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2620 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2621 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2622
2623 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2624 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2625 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2626 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2627 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2628 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2629
2630 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2631 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2632 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2633 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2634 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2635
2636 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2637 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2638 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2639 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2640 single-register-class
2641 @c [later: or memory]
2642 output constraint.
2643
2644 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2645 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2646 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2647 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2648
2649 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2650 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2651 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2652 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2653 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2654 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2655 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2656 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2657
2658
2659 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2660 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2661 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2662 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2663
2664 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2665 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2666 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2667
2668 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2669 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2670 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2671 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2672 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2673 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2674 @end deftypefn
2675
2676 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2678 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2679 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2680 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2681
2682 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2683 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2684 reload phase that it may
2685 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2686 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2687 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2688 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2689 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2690 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2691
2692 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2693 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2694 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2695 class required. If the
2696 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2697 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2698 macros identically.
2699
2700 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2701 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2702 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2703 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2704 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2705
2706 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2707 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2708 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2709 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2710 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2711 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2712 register.
2713
2714 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2715 register that
2716 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2717 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2718 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2719 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2720 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2721
2722 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2723 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2724 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2725 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2726
2727 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2728 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2729 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2730 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2731 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2732 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2733 general registers.
2734 @end defmac
2735
2736 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2737 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2738 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2739 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2740 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2741 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2742 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2743
2744 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2745 @end defmac
2746
2747 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2748 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2749 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2750 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2751 defined by this macro.
2752
2753 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2754 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2755 @end defmac
2756
2757 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2758 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2759 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2760 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2761 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2762 same as that of @var{mode}.
2763
2764 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2765 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2766 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2767 registers.
2768
2769 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2770 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2771 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2772 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2773 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2774 details.
2775
2776 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2777 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2778 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2779 @end defmac
2780
2781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2782 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2783 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2784 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2785
2786 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2787 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2788 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2789 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2790 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2791
2792 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2793 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2794 pressure.
2795 @end deftypefn
2796
2797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2798 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2799 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2800
2801 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2802 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2803 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2804 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2805 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2806
2807 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2808 in the reload pass.
2809
2810 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2811 in words.
2812 @end deftypefn
2813
2814 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2815 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2816 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2817
2818 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2819 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2820 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2821 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2822
2823 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2824 in the reload pass.
2825 @end defmac
2826
2827 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2828 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2829 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2830
2831 For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2832 floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2833 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2834 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2835 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2836 as below:
2837
2838 @smallexample
2839 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2840 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2841 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2842 @end smallexample
2843
2844 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2845 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2846 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2847 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2848 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2849 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2850 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2851 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2852 value that the middle-end intended.
2853
2854 @end defmac
2855
2856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2857 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2858 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2859
2860 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2861 @end deftypefn
2862
2863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2864 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns always false, but new ports should use LRA.
2865 @end deftypefn
2866
2867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2868 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2869 @end deftypefn
2870
2871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2872 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2873 @end deftypefn
2874
2875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2876 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2877 @end deftypefn
2878
2879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2880 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2881 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2882 register allocation.
2883 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2884 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2885 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2886 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2887 @end deftypefn
2888
2889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2890 A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2891 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2892 at memory mode @var{mode}.
2893 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2894 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2895 addressing.
2896 @end deftypefn
2897
2898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2899 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2900 @end deftypefn
2901
2902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2903 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2904 @end deftypefn
2905
2906 @node Stack and Calling
2907 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2908 @cindex calling conventions
2909
2910 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2911 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2912
2913 @menu
2914 * Frame Layout::
2915 * Exception Handling::
2916 * Stack Checking::
2917 * Frame Registers::
2918 * Elimination::
2919 * Stack Arguments::
2920 * Register Arguments::
2921 * Scalar Return::
2922 * Aggregate Return::
2923 * Caller Saves::
2924 * Function Entry::
2925 * Profiling::
2926 * Tail Calls::
2927 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2928 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2929 @end menu
2930
2931 @node Frame Layout
2932 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2933 @cindex stack frame layout
2934 @cindex frame layout
2935
2936 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2937 Here is the basic stack layout.
2938
2939 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2940 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2941 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2942 @end defmac
2943
2944 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2945 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2946 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2947 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2948
2949 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2950 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2951 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2952 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2953 space for the next item on the stack.
2954
2955 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2956 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2957 which is often wrong.
2958 @end defmac
2959
2960 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2961 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2962 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2963 @end defmac
2964
2965 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2966 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2967 addresses on the stack.
2968 @end defmac
2969
2970 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2971 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2972
2973 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2974 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2975 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2976 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2977 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2978 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2979 @end defmac
2980
2981 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2982 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2983 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2984
2985 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2986 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2987 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2988 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2989 @end defmac
2990
2991 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2992 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2993 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2994 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2995
2996 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2997 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2998 @end defmac
2999
3000 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3001 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3002 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3003 function.
3004
3005 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3006 the first argument's address.
3007 @end defmac
3008
3009 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3010 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3011 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3012
3013 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3014 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3015 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3016 @end defmac
3017
3018 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3019 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3020 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3021 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3022 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3023 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3024 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3025 @end defmac
3026
3027 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3028 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3029 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3030 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3031 itself.
3032
3033 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3034 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3035 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3036 @end defmac
3037
3038 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3039 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3040 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3041 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3042 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3043 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3044 @end defmac
3045
3046 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3047 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3048 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3049 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3050 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3051 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3052 @end deftypefn
3053
3054 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3055 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3056 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3057 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3058 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3059 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3060 @end defmac
3061
3062 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3063 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3064 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3065 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3066 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3067 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3068
3069 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3070 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3071 determine the return address of other frames.
3072 @end defmac
3073
3074 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3075 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3076 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3077 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3078 @end defmac
3079
3080 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3081 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3082 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3083 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3084 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3085 the stack.
3086
3087 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3088 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3089
3090 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3091 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3092 @end defmac
3093
3094 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3095 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3096 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3097 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3098 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3099
3100 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3101 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3102 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3103 over time.
3104 @end defmac
3105
3106 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3107 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3108 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3109 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3110 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3111 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3112 @end defmac
3113
3114 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3115 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3116 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3117 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3118 @smallexample
3119 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3120 @end smallexample
3121 and
3122 @smallexample
3123 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3124 @end smallexample
3125 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3126 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3127 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3128 @end deftypefn
3129
3130 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3131 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3132 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3133 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3134 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3135 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3136
3137 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3138 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3139 @end defmac
3140
3141 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3142 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3143 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3144 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3145 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3146 during virtual register instantiation.
3147
3148 The default value for this macro is
3149 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3150 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3151 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3152 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3153 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3154
3155 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3156 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3157 DWARF 2.
3158 @end defmac
3159
3160 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3161 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3162 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3163 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3164 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3165
3166 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3167 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3168 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3169 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3170 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3171 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3172 should be defined.
3173 @end defmac
3174
3175 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3176 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3177 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3178 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3179 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3180 @end defmac
3181
3182 @node Exception Handling
3183 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3184 @cindex exception handling
3185
3186 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3187 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3188 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3189 @var{N} registers are usable.
3190
3191 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3192 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3193 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3194 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3195 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3196
3197 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3198 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3199 @end defmac
3200
3201 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3202 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3203 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3204 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3205 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3206
3207 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3208 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3209
3210 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3211 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3212 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3213 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3214 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3215 that provided by DWARF 2.
3216 @end defmac
3217
3218 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3219 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3220 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3221 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3222
3223 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3224 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3225 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3226 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3227 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3228 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3229 target call frame.
3230
3231 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3232 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3233 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3234
3235 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3236 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3237 @end defmac
3238
3239 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3240 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3241 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3242 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3243 using it to return to the exception handler.
3244 @end defmac
3245
3246 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3247 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3248 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3249 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3250 and so may be read-only.
3251
3252 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3253 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3254 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3255 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3256
3257 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3258 represented directly.
3259 @end defmac
3260
3261 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3262 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3263 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3264 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3265 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3266
3267 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3268 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3269 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3270 to be emitted.
3271 @end defmac
3272
3273 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3274 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3275 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3276 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3277 through signal frames.
3278
3279 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3280 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3281 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3282 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3283 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3284 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3285 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3286 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3287 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3288
3289 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3290 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3291 @end defmac
3292
3293 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3294 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3295 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3296 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3297
3298 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3299 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3300 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3301 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3302 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3303 be updated in @var{fs}.
3304 @end defmac
3305
3306 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3307 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3308 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3309 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3310 @end defmac
3311
3312 @node Stack Checking
3313 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3314
3315 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3316 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3317 three ways:
3318
3319 @enumerate
3320 @item
3321 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3322 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3323 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3324 other special processing.
3325
3326 @item
3327 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3328 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3329 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3330 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3331 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3332 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3333 approach below.
3334
3335 @item
3336 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3337 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3338 @end enumerate
3339
3340 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3341 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3342 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3343 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3344
3345 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3346 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3347 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3348 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3349 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3350 value of this macro is zero.
3351 @end defmac
3352
3353 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3354 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3355 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3356 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3357 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3358 @end defmac
3359
3360 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3361 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3362 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3363 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3364 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3365 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3366 @end defmac
3367
3368 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3369 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3370 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3371 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3372 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3373 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3374 default value of this macro is zero.
3375 @end defmac
3376
3377 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3378 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3379 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3380 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3381 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3382 architectures and operating systems.
3383 @end defmac
3384
3385 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3386 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3387 in the opposite case.
3388
3389 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3390 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3391 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3392 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3393 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3394 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3395 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3396 @end defmac
3397
3398 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3399 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3400 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3401 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3402 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3403 use the default of four words.
3404 @end defmac
3405
3406 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3407 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3408 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3409 @option{-fstack-check}.
3410 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3411 normally not need to override that default.
3412 @end defmac
3413
3414 @need 2000
3415 @node Frame Registers
3416 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3417
3418 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3419 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3420
3421 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3422 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3423 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3424 the hardware determines which register this is.
3425 @end defmac
3426
3427 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3428 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3429 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3430 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3431 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3432 @end defmac
3433
3434 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3435 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3436 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3437 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3438 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3439 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3440 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3441 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3442 used for the frame pointer.
3443
3444 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3445 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3446 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3447 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3448 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3449 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3450 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3451
3452 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3453 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3454 @end defmac
3455
3456 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3457 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3458 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3459 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3460 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3461 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3462 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3463 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3464 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3465 @end defmac
3466
3467 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3468 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3469 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3470 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3471 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3472 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3473 @end defmac
3474
3475 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3476 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3477 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3478 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3479 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3480 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3481 @end defmac
3482
3483 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3484 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3485 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3486 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3487 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3488 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3489 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3490
3491 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3492 address from the stack.
3493 @end defmac
3494
3495 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3496 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3497 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3498 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3499 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3500 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3501 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3502 not be defined.
3503
3504 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3505
3506 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3507 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3508 @end defmac
3509
3510 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3511 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3512 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3513 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3514 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3515 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3516
3517 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3518
3519 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3520 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3521 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3522 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3523 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3524 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3525 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3526 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3527 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3528 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3529 to refer to those items.
3530 @end deftypefn
3531
3532 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3533 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3534 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3535 DWARF2 exception handling.
3536
3537 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3538 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3539 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3540 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3541 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3542 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3543 registers that are not call-saved.
3544
3545 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3546 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3547 @end defmac
3548
3549 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3550
3551 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3552 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3553
3554 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3555 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3556 @end defmac
3557
3558 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3559
3560 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3561 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3562 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3563 column number to use instead.
3564
3565 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3566 @end defmac
3567
3568 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3569
3570 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3571 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3572 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3573 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3574 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3575
3576 @end defmac
3577
3578 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3579
3580 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3581 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3582 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3583 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3584 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3585
3586 @end defmac
3587
3588 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3589
3590 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3591 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3592 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3593 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3594
3595 @end defmac
3596
3597 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3598
3599 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3600 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3601 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3602 defined and 0 otherwise.
3603
3604 @end defmac
3605
3606 @node Elimination
3607 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3608
3609 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3610 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3611
3612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3613 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3614 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3615 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3616
3617 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3618 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3619 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3620 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3621 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3622 pointer.
3623
3624 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3625 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3626 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3627 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3628 them.
3629
3630 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3631 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3632 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3633
3634 Default return value is @code{false}.
3635 @end deftypefn
3636
3637 @findex get_frame_size
3638 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3639 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3640 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3641 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3642 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3643 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3644
3645 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3646 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3647 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3648 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3649 @end defmac
3650
3651 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3652 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3653 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3654 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3655 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3656
3657 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3658 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3659
3660 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3661 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3662 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3663 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3664 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3665
3666 In this case, you might specify:
3667 @smallexample
3668 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3669 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3670 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3671 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3672 @end smallexample
3673
3674 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3675 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3676 @end defmac
3677
3678 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3679 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3680 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3681 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3682 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3683 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3684 knows about.
3685
3686 Default return value is @code{true}.
3687 @end deftypefn
3688
3689 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3690 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3691 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3692 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3693 defined.
3694 @end defmac
3695
3696 @node Stack Arguments
3697 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3698 @cindex arguments on stack
3699 @cindex stack arguments
3700
3701 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3702 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3703 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3704
3705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3706 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3707 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3708 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3709 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3710 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3711 @end deftypefn
3712
3713 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3714 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3715 outgoing arguments.
3716 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3717 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3718 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3719 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3720 @end defmac
3721
3722 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3723 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3724 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3725 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3726 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3727 @end defmac
3728
3729 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3730 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3731 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3732
3733 On some machines, the definition
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @noindent
3740 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3741 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3742 alignment. Then the definition should be
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3746 @end smallexample
3747
3748 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3749 @end defmac
3750
3751 @findex outgoing_args_size
3752 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3753 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3754 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3755 will be computed and placed into
3756 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3757 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3758 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3759
3760 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3761 is not proper.
3762 @end defmac
3763
3764 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3765 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3766 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3767 registers.
3768
3769 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3770 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3771 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3772 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3773 of the function.
3774
3775 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3776 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3777 which.
3778 @end defmac
3779 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3780 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3781
3782 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3783 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3784 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3785 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3786 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3787 @end defmac
3788
3789 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3790 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3791 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3792 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3793 if the function called is a library function.
3794
3795 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3796 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3797 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3798 @end defmac
3799
3800 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3801 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3802 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3803 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3804 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3805
3806 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3807 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3808 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3809 stack in its natural location.
3810 @end defmac
3811
3812 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3813 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3814 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3815 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3816
3817 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3818 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3819 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3820 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3821
3822 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3823 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3824 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3825 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3826 arguments (if known).
3827
3828 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3829 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3830 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3831 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3832 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3833 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3834
3835 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3836 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3837 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3838
3839 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3840 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3841 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3842 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3843 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3844 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3845 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3846 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3847 number of arguments.
3848 @end deftypefn
3849
3850 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3851 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3852 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3853 when compiling a function call.
3854
3855 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3856 have been accumulated.
3857
3858 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3859 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3860 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3861 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3862 appropriate.
3863 @end defmac
3864
3865 @node Register Arguments
3866 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3867 @cindex arguments in registers
3868 @cindex registers arguments
3869
3870 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3871 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3872 the stack.
3873
3874 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3875 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3876 register and if so, which register.
3877
3878 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3879 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3880 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3881 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3882 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3883 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3884 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3885 syntax error has previously occurred.
3886
3887 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3888 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3889 on the stack.
3890
3891 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3892 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3893 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3894 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3895 for more information.
3896
3897 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3898 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3899 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3900 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3901 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3902 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3903 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3904 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3905 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3906 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3907 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3908 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3909 argument is also stored on the stack.
3910
3911 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3912 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3913 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3914
3915 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3916 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3917 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3918 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3919 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3920 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3921
3922 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3923 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3924 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3925 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3926 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3927 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3928 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3929 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3930 a register.
3931 @end deftypefn
3932
3933 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3934 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3935 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3936 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3937 documentation.
3938 @end deftypefn
3939
3940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3941 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
3942 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
3943 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
3944 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
3945
3946 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3947 which the caller passes the value, and
3948 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3949 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3950 arrive.
3951
3952 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
3953 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
3954 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
3955
3956 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3957 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3958 @end deftypefn
3959
3960 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3961 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3962 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3963 @end deftypefn
3964
3965 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3966 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3967 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3968 @end deftypefn
3969
3970 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3971 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3972 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3973 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3974 pushed on the stack.
3975
3976 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3977 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3978 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3979 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3980 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3981 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3982 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3983
3984 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3985 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3986 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3987 @end deftypefn
3988
3989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3990 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3991 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
3992 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3993 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3994
3995 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3996 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3997 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3998 to that type.
3999 @end deftypefn
4000
4001 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4002 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4003 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4004 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4005 by the caller.
4006
4007 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4008 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4009 not be generated.
4010
4011 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4012 @end deftypefn
4013
4014 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4015 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4016 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4017 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4018 of bytes of argument so far.
4019
4020 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4021 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4022 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4023 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4024 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4025 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4026 @end defmac
4027
4028 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4029 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4030 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4031 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4032 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4033 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4034 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4035 @end defmac
4036
4037 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4038 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4039 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4040 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4041 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4042 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4043 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4044 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4045 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4046 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4047 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4048 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4049 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4050
4051 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4052 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4053 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4054 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4055 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4056 never both of them at once.
4057 @end defmac
4058
4059 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4060 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4061 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4062 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4063 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4064 0)} is used instead.
4065 @end defmac
4066
4067 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4068 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4069 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4070 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4071
4072 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4073 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4074 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4075 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4076 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4077 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4078 @end defmac
4079
4080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4081 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4082 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4083 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4084 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4085 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4086
4087 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4088 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4089 used for arguments without any special help.
4090 @end deftypefn
4091
4092 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4093 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4094 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4095 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4096 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4097 top.
4098 @end defmac
4099
4100 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4101 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4102 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4103 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4104 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4105
4106 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4107 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4108 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4109
4110 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4111 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4112 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4113 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4114 @end defmac
4115
4116 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4117 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4118 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4119 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4120 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4121 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4122 @end defmac
4123
4124 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4125 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4126 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4127 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4128 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4129 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4130 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4131 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4132 required.
4133 @end defmac
4134
4135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4136 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4137 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4138 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4139 @end deftypefn
4140
4141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4142 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4143 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4144 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4145 value.
4146 @end deftypefn
4147
4148 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4149 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4150 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4151 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4152 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4153 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4154 stack.
4155 @end defmac
4156
4157 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4158 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4159 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4160 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4161 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4162 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4163 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4164 point register.
4165
4166 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4167 false.
4168 @end deftypefn
4169
4170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4171 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4172 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4173 @end deftypefn
4174
4175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4176 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4177 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4178 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4179 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4180 variable.
4181 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4182 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4183 internal type.
4184 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4185 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4186 macro to iterate through all types.
4187 @end deftypefn
4188
4189 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4190 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4191 @var{fndecl}.
4192 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4193 @end deftypefn
4194
4195 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4196 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4197 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4198 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4199 @end deftypefn
4200
4201 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4202 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4203 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4204 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4205 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4206 @end deftypefn
4207
4208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4209 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4210 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4211 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4212 @end deftypefn
4213
4214 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4215 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4216 @end deftypefn
4217
4218 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4219 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4220 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4221 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4222 must work.
4223
4224 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4225 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4226 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4227 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4228 @end deftypefn
4229
4230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4231 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4232 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4233 must have move patterns for this mode.
4234 @end deftypefn
4235
4236 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4237 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4238 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4239 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4240 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4241
4242 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4243 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4244 has operations like:
4245
4246 @smallexample
4247 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4248 @end smallexample
4249
4250 where the return type is defined as:
4251
4252 @smallexample
4253 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4254 @{
4255 int8x8_t val[3];
4256 @} int8x8x3_t;
4257 @end smallexample
4258
4259 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4260 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4261 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4262 @end deftypefn
4263
4264 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4265 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4266 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4267 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4268 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4269 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4270 @end deftypefn
4271
4272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4273 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4274 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4275 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4276 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4277 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4278 for any mode.
4279
4280 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4281 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4282 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4283 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4284 insn.
4285
4286 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4287 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4288 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4289 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4290 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4291 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4292 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4293 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4294 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4295
4296 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4297 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4298 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4299 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4300 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4301 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4302 @end deftypefn
4303
4304 @node Scalar Return
4305 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4306 @cindex return values in registers
4307 @cindex values, returned by functions
4308 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4309
4310 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4311 values---values that can fit in registers.
4312
4313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4314
4315 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4316 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4317 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4318 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4319 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4320 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4321 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4322 a function returns a value.
4323
4324 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4325 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4326 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4327 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4328 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4329 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4330 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4331 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4332 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4333 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4334 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4335 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4336
4337 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4338 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4339 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4340
4341 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4342 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4343 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4344 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4345 known.
4346
4347 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4348 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4349 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4350 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4351
4352 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4353 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4354 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4355 @end deftypefn
4356
4357 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4358 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4359 a new target instead.
4360 @end defmac
4361
4362 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4363 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4364 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4365
4366 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4367 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4368 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4369 compiled.
4370 @end defmac
4371
4372 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4373 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4374 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4375
4376 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4377 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4378 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4379
4380 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4381 @end deftypefn
4382
4383 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4384 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4385 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4386
4387 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4388 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4389 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4390 suffices:
4391
4392 @smallexample
4393 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4394 @end smallexample
4395
4396 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4397 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4398 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4399
4400 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4401 for a new target instead.
4402 @end defmac
4403
4404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4405 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4406 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4407
4408 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4409 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4410 recognized by this target hook.
4411
4412 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4413 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4414 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4415
4416 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4417 @end deftypefn
4418
4419 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4420 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4421 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4422 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4423 @end defmac
4424
4425 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4426 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4427 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4428 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4429 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4430 undesirable on your target.
4431 @end deftypevr
4432
4433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4434 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4435 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4436 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4437 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4438
4439 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4440 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4441 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4442 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4443 @code{SImode} rtx.
4444 @end deftypefn
4445
4446 @node Aggregate Return
4447 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4448 @cindex aggregates as return values
4449 @cindex large return values
4450 @cindex returning aggregate values
4451 @cindex structure value address
4452
4453 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4454 cases), the value is not returned according to
4455 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4456 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4457 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4458 address}.
4459
4460 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4461 memory.
4462
4463 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4464 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4465 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4466 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4467 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4468 libcalls.
4469
4470 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4471 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4472 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4473 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4474 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4475 values, and 0 otherwise.
4476
4477 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4478 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4479 to indicate this.
4480 @end deftypefn
4481
4482 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4483 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4484 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4485 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4486 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4487 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4488 target hook.
4489
4490 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4491 @end defmac
4492
4493 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4494 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4495 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4496 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4497 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4498 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4499 argument.
4500
4501 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4502 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4503 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4504 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4505 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4506 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4507 the caller.
4508
4509 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4510 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4511 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4512 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4513 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4514 @end deftypefn
4515
4516 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4517 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4518 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4519 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4520
4521 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4522 pass an address to the subroutine.
4523
4524 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4525 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4526 @end defmac
4527
4528 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4529 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4530 @end deftypefn
4531
4532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4533 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4534 @end deftypefn
4535
4536 @node Caller Saves
4537 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4538
4539 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4540 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4541 must live across calls.
4542
4543 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4544 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4545 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4546 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4547 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4548 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4549 @end defmac
4550
4551 @node Function Entry
4552 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4553 @cindex function entry and exit
4554 @cindex prologue
4555 @cindex epilogue
4556
4557 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4558 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4559
4560 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4561 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4562 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4563 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4564 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4565 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4566 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4567
4568 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4569 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4570
4571 @findex regs_ever_live
4572 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4573 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4574 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4575 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4576 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4577 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4578
4579 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4580 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4581 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4582 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4583 registers are used in the function.
4584
4585 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4586 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4587 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4588 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4589 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4590 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4591 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4592
4593 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4594 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4595 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4596 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4597 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4598 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4599 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4600 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4601 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4602 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4603 @end deftypefn
4604
4605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4606 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4607 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4608 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4609 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4610 @end deftypefn
4611
4612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4613 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4614 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4615 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4616 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4617 @end deftypefn
4618
4619 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4620 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4621 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4622 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4623 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4624 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4625 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4626 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4627
4628 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4629 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4630 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4631 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4632
4633 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4634 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4635 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4636 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4637 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4638 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4639
4640 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4641 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4642 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4643 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4644 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4645 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4646
4647 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4648 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4649 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4650 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4651
4652 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4653 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4654 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4655 number of arguments.
4656
4657 @findex pops_args
4658 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4659 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4660 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4661 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4662 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4663 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4664 @end deftypefn
4665
4666 @itemize @bullet
4667 @item
4668 @findex pretend_args_size
4669 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4670 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4671 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4672 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4673 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4674 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4675 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4676 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4677 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4678 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4679
4680 @item
4681 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4682 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4683 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4684 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4685 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4686 a save area.
4687
4688 @item
4689 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4690 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4691 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4692 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4693
4694 @item
4695 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4696 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4697 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4698 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4699 @end itemize
4700
4701 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4702 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4703 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4704 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4705 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4706 default is 0.
4707
4708 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4709 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4710 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4711 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4712 @end defmac
4713
4714 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4715 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4716 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4717 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4718 @end defmac
4719
4720 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4721 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4722 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4723 on entry to an exception edge.
4724 @end defmac
4725
4726 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4727 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4728 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4729 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4730 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4731 the real function.
4732
4733 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4734 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4735 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4736 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4737 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4738 all other incoming arguments.
4739
4740 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4741 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4742 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4743
4744 @smallexample
4745 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4746 @end smallexample
4747
4748 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4749 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4750 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4751 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4752
4753 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4754 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4755 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4756 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4757
4758 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4759 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4760 some targets, but probably not.
4761
4762 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4763 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4764 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4765 not support varargs.
4766 @end deftypefn
4767
4768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4769 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4770 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4771 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4772 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4773 previously exposed.
4774 @end deftypefn
4775
4776 @node Profiling
4777 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4778 @cindex profiling, code generation
4779
4780 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4781
4782 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4783 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4784 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4785
4786 @findex mcount
4787 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4788 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4789 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4790 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4791
4792 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4793 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4794 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4795 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4796 @end defmac
4797
4798 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4799 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4800 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4801 not support profiling.
4802 @end defmac
4803
4804 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4805 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4806 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4807 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4808 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4809 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4810 @end defmac
4811
4812 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4813 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4814 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4815 @end defmac
4816
4817 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4818 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4819 @end deftypefn
4820
4821 @node Tail Calls
4822 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4823 @cindex tail calls
4824
4825 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4826 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4827 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4828 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4829
4830 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4831 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4832 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4833 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4834 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4835 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4836 @end deftypefn
4837
4838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4839 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4840 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4841 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4842 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4843 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4844 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4845 @end deftypefn
4846
4847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4848 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4849 @end deftypefn
4850
4851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4852 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4853 @end deftypefn
4854
4855 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4856 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4857 @cindex stack smashing protection
4858
4859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4860 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4861 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4862 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4863 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4864 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4865
4866 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4867 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4868 @end deftypefn
4869
4870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4871 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4872 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4873 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4874
4875 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4876 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4877 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4878 @end deftypefn
4879
4880 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4881 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4882 @end deftypefn
4883
4884 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4885 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4886 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4887
4888 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
4889 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4890 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4891 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4892 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4893 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4894 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4895 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4896 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
4897 @end deftypevr
4898
4899 @node Varargs
4900 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4901 @cindex varargs implementation
4902
4903 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4904 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4905 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4906 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4907 conditionals to include it.
4908
4909 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4910 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4911 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4912 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4913 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4914 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4915
4916 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4917 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4918 below.
4919
4920 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4921 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4922 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4923 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4924 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4925
4926 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4927 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4928 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4929 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4930
4931 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4932 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4933 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4934 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4935 to use them for its own purposes.
4936 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4937 @c 10feb93
4938 @end defmac
4939
4940 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4941 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4942 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4943 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4944 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4945 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4946 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4947 of the current function.
4948 @end defmac
4949
4950 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4951 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4952 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4953 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4954 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4955 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4956
4957 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4958 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4959 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4960
4961 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4962 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4963 @end defmac
4964
4965 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4966
4967 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4968 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4969 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4970 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4971 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4972 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4973 @end deftypefn
4974
4975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
4976 This target hook offers an alternative to using
4977 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4978 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4979 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4980 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4981 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4982 pass all their arguments on the stack.
4983
4984 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4985 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4986 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4987 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4988
4989 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4990 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4991 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4992 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4993 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4994 frame.
4995
4996 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4997 compile time without knowing their data types,
4998 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4999 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5000 for all data types.
5001
5002 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5003 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5004 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5005 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5006 not generate any instructions in this case.
5007 @end deftypefn
5008
5009 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5010 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5011 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5012
5013 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5014 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5015 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5016 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5017 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5018 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5019 except the last are treated as named.
5020
5021 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5022 @end deftypefn
5023
5024 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5025 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5026 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5027 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5028 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5029 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5030 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5031 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5032 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5033 registers if a target needs it.
5034 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5035 passed instead of an argument register.
5036 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5037 @end deftypefn
5038
5039 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5040 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5041 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5042 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5043 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5044 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5045 @end deftypefn
5046
5047 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5048 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5049 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5050 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5051 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5052 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5053 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5054 @end deftypefn
5055
5056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5057 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5058 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5059 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5060 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5061 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5062 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5063 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5064 @end deftypefn
5065
5066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5067 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5068 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5069 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5070 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5071 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5072 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5073 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5074 @end deftypefn
5075
5076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5077 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5078 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5079 loaded bounds.
5080 @end deftypefn
5081
5082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5083 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5084 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5085 @end deftypefn
5086
5087 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5088 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5089 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5090 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5091 @end deftypefn
5092
5093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5094 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5095 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5096 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5097 @end deftypefn
5098
5099 @node Trampolines
5100 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5101 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5102 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5103
5104 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5105 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5106 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5107 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5108 trampoline.
5109
5110 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5111 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5112 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5113 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5114 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5115 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5116 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5117 operands.
5118
5119 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5120 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5121 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5122 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5123 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5124 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5125 separately.
5126
5127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5128 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5129 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5130 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5131 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5132
5133 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5134 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5135 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5136 to generate it on the spot.
5137 @end deftypefn
5138
5139 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5140 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5141 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5142 @end defmac
5143
5144 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5145 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5146 @end defmac
5147
5148 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5149 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5150
5151 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5152 is used for aligning trampolines.
5153 @end defmac
5154
5155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5156 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5157 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5158 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5159 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5160 when it is called.
5161
5162 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5163 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5164 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5165 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5166 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5167 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5168
5169 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5170 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5171 initializing the trampoline proper.
5172 @end deftypefn
5173
5174 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5175 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5176 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5177 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5178 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5179 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5180 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5181 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5182 @end deftypefn
5183
5184 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5185 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5186 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5187 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5188
5189 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5190 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5191 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5192 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5193 latter makes initialization faster.
5194
5195 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5196 the following macro.
5197
5198 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5199 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5200 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5201 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5202 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5203 @end defmac
5204
5205 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5206 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5207 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5208 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5209 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5210
5211 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5212 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5213 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5214 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5215 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5216
5217 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5218 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5219 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5220 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5221 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5222 special assembler code.
5223 @end defmac
5224
5225 @node Library Calls
5226 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5227 @cindex library subroutine names
5228 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5229
5230 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5231 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5232
5233 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5234 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5235 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5236 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5237 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5238 @end defmac
5239
5240 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5241 @findex init_one_libfunc
5242 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5243 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5244 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5245 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5246 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5247 library routines.
5248
5249 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5250 @end deftypefn
5251
5252 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5253 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5254 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5255 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5256 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5257 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5258 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5259 @end deftypevr
5260
5261 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5262 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5263 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5264 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5265 return a tristate.
5266
5267 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5268 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5269 don't need to define this macro.
5270 @end defmac
5271
5272 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5273 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5274 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5275 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5276 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5277 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5278 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5279 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5280 @end defmac
5281
5282 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5283 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5284 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5285 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5286 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5287 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5288 @end defmac
5289
5290 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5291 @findex matherr
5292 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5293 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5294 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5295 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5296 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5297 system.
5298
5299 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5300 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5301 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5302 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5303 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5304 @end defmac
5305
5306 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5307 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5308 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5309 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5310 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5311 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5312 @end defmac
5313
5314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5315 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5316 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5317 @end deftypefn
5318
5319 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5320 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5321 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5322 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5323 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5324 the NeXT runtime installed.
5325
5326 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5327 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5328 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5329
5330 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5331 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5332 @end defmac
5333
5334 @node Addressing Modes
5335 @section Addressing Modes
5336 @cindex addressing modes
5337
5338 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5339 This is about addressing modes.
5340
5341 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5342 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5343 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5344 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5345 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5346 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5347 @end defmac
5348
5349 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5350 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5351 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5352 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5353 the size of the memory operand.
5354 @end defmac
5355
5356 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5357 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5358 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5359 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5360 @end defmac
5361
5362 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5363 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5364 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5365 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5366 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5367 constant addresses are supported.
5368 @end defmac
5369
5370 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5371 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5372 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5373 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5374 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5375 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5376 @end defmac
5377
5378 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5379 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5380 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5381 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5382 accept.
5383 @end defmac
5384
5385 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5386 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5387 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5388
5389 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5390 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5391 desired by the caller.
5392
5393 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5394 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5395 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5396 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5397 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5398 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5399 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5400 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5401
5402 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5403 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5404 register is required.
5405
5406 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5407 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5408 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5409 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5410 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5411
5412 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5413 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5414 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5415 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5416 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5417
5418 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5419 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5420 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5421 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5422 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5423 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5424 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5425 Format}.
5426
5427 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5428 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5429 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5430 has this syntax:
5431
5432 @example
5433 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5434 @end example
5435
5436 @noindent
5437 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5438 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5439
5440 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5441 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5442 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5443 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5444 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5445
5446 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5447 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5448 @end deftypefn
5449
5450 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5451 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5452 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5453 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5454 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5455 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5456 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5457 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5458 @code{'m'} constraint.
5459 @end defmac
5460
5461 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5462 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5463 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5464 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5465 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5466
5467 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5468 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5469
5470 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5471 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5472 @end defmac
5473
5474 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5475 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5476 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5477 address.
5478
5479 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5480 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5481 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5482 @var{x}.
5483
5484 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5485 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5486 should return the new @var{x}.
5487
5488 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5489 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5490 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5491 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5492 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5493 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5494 strategy can generate better code.
5495 @end deftypefn
5496
5497 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5498 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5499 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5500 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5501 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5502 performance reasons.
5503
5504 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5505 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5506 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5507 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5508 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5509 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5510 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5511 be shared.
5512
5513 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5514 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5515 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5516 of reload internals.
5517
5518 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5519 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5520 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5521
5522 @findex push_reload
5523 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5524 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5525 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5526
5527 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5528 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5529 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5530 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5531 @code{push_reload}.
5532
5533 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5534 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5535 the address has become legitimate.
5536
5537 @findex copy_rtx
5538 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5539 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5540 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5541 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5542 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5543 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5544 @end defmac
5545
5546 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5547 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5548 space @var{addrspace} can have
5549 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5550 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5551 but not others.
5552
5553 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5554 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5555 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5556 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5557
5558 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5559
5560 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5561 @end deftypefn
5562
5563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5564 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5565 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5566 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5567
5568 The default definition returns true.
5569 @end deftypefn
5570
5571 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5572 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5573 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5574 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5575 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5576 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5577 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5578 into their original form.
5579 @end deftypefn
5580
5581 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5582 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5583 debug sections.
5584 @end deftypefn
5585
5586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5587 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5588 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5589 of @var{x}.
5590
5591 The default version of this hook returns false.
5592
5593 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5594 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5595 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5596 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5597 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5598 @end deftypefn
5599
5600 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5601 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5602 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5603 of @var{x}.
5604
5605 The default version returns false for all constants.
5606 @end deftypefn
5607
5608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5609 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5610 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5611
5612 The default version returns true for all decls.
5613 @end deftypefn
5614
5615 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5616 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5617 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5618 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5619 @end deftypefn
5620
5621 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5622 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5623 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5624 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5625 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5626
5627 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5628 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5629 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5630 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5631 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5632 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5633 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5634 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5635 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5636 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5637 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5638
5639 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5640 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5641 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5642 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5643 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5644 described above.
5645 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5646 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5647 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5648 @end deftypefn
5649
5650 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5651 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5652 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5653 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5654 @end deftypefn
5655
5656 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5657 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5658 @end deftypefn
5659
5660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5661 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5662 @end deftypefn
5663
5664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5665 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5666 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5667 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5668 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5669 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5670
5671 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5672 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5673 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5674 @end deftypefn
5675
5676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5677 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5678 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5679 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5680 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5681 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5682 @end deftypefn
5683
5684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5685 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5686 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5687 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5688 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5689 @end deftypefn
5690
5691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5692 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5693 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5694 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5695 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5696 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5697 @end deftypefn
5698
5699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
5700 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5701 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5702 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5703 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5704 @end deftypefn
5705
5706 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5707 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5708 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5709 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5710 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5711 @end deftypefn
5712
5713 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5714 This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5715 of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5716 vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5717 @end deftypefn
5718
5719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5720 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5721 @end deftypefn
5722
5723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5724 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5725 @end deftypefn
5726
5727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5728 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5729 @end deftypefn
5730
5731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5732 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5733 @end deftypefn
5734
5735 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5736 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5737 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5738 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5739 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5740 loads.
5741 @end deftypefn
5742
5743 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5744 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5745 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5746 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5747 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5748 stores.
5749 @end deftypefn
5750
5751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5752 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5753 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5754 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5755 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5756 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5757 @end deftypefn
5758
5759 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5760 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5761 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5762 @end deftypefn
5763
5764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5765 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5766 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5767 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5768 to use it.
5769 @end deftypefn
5770
5771 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
5772 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5773 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
5774 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
5775 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
5776 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
5777 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
5778 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
5779 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
5780 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5781 provide dimensions larger than 1.
5782 @end deftypefn
5783
5784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5785 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5786 or zero if unbounded.
5787 @end deftypefn
5788
5789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
5790 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5791 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5792 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5793 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5794 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5795 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5796 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
5797 @end deftypefn
5798
5799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5800 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5801 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5802 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5803 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5804 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5805 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5806 @end deftypefn
5807
5808 @node Anchored Addresses
5809 @section Anchored Addresses
5810 @cindex anchored addresses
5811 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5812
5813 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5814 For example, if we have:
5815
5816 @smallexample
5817 static int a, b, c;
5818 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5819 @end smallexample
5820
5821 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5822 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5823 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5824 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5825 be something like:
5826
5827 @smallexample
5828 int foo (void)
5829 @{
5830 register int *xr = &x;
5831 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5832 @}
5833 @end smallexample
5834
5835 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5836 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5837
5838 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5839 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5840 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5841 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5842
5843 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5844 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5845 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5846 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5847 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5848 @end deftypevr
5849
5850 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5851 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5852 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5853 value is 0.
5854 @end deftypevr
5855
5856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5857 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5858 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5859 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5860 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5861
5862 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5863 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5864 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5865 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5866 @end deftypefn
5867
5868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5869 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5870 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5871 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5872
5873 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5874 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5875 or target-specific sections.
5876 @end deftypefn
5877
5878 @node Condition Code
5879 @section Condition Code Status
5880 @cindex condition code status
5881
5882 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5883 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5884
5885 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5886 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5887 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5888 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5889 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5890 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5891 most RISC machines.
5892
5893 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5894 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5895 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5896 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5897 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5898 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5899
5900 These restrictions can prevent important
5901 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5902 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5903 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5904 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5905 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5906
5907 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5908 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5909 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5910 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5911 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5912 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5913 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5914
5915 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5916 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5917 interested in most macros in this section.
5918
5919 @menu
5920 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5921 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5922 @end menu
5923
5924 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5925 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5926 @findex cc0
5927
5928 @findex cc_status
5929 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5930 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5931 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5932 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5933 currently based, and several standard flags.
5934
5935 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5936 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5937 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5938
5939 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5940 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5941 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5942
5943 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5944 @end defmac
5945
5946 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5947 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5948 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5949 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5950 define this macro to initialize it.
5951
5952 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5953 @end defmac
5954
5955 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5956 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5957 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5958 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5959 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5960 set @code{(cc0)}.
5961
5962 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5963
5964 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5965 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5966 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5967 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5968 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5969 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5970 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5971 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5972 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5973 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5974 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5975 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5976 condition code value.
5977
5978 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5979 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5980 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5981 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5982 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5983 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5984 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5985
5986 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5987 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5988 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5989 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5990 @end defmac
5991
5992 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5993 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5994 @findex CCmode
5995 @findex MODE_CC
5996
5997 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5998 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5999 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6000 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6001 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6002 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6003 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6004 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6005 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6006 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6007 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6008
6009 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6010 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6011 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6012 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6013 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6014 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6015 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6016
6017 @smallexample
6018 (define_insn ""
6019 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6020 (compare:CC_NOOV
6021 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6022 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6023 (const_int 0)))]
6024 ""
6025 "@dots{}")
6026 @end smallexample
6027
6028 @noindent
6029 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6030 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6031
6032 @smallexample
6033 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6034 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6035 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6036 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6037 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6038 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6039 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6040 @end smallexample
6041
6042 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6043 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6044 this section.
6045
6046 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6047 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6048 @end defmac
6049
6050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6051 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6052 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6053 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6054 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6055
6056 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6057 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6058 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6059 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6060 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6061 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6062 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6063
6064 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6065 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6066 @file{md} file.
6067
6068 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6069 comparison code or operands.
6070 @end deftypefn
6071
6072 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6073 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6074 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6075 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6076 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6077
6078 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6079 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6080 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6081 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6085 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6086 @end smallexample
6087 @end defmac
6088
6089 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6090 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6091 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6092 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6093 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6094 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6095 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6096 like:
6097
6098 @smallexample
6099 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6100 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6101 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6102 @end smallexample
6103 @end defmac
6104
6105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6106 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6107 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6108 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6109 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6110 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6111 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6112 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6113 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6114 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6115 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6116
6117 The default version of this hook returns false.
6118 @end deftypefn
6119
6120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6121 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6122 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6123 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6124 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6125 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6126 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6127
6128 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6129 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6130 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6131 @end deftypefn
6132
6133 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6134 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6135 @end deftypevr
6136
6137 @node Costs
6138 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6139 @cindex costs of instructions
6140 @cindex relative costs
6141 @cindex speed of instructions
6142
6143 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6144 on the target machine.
6145
6146 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6147 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6148 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6149 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6150 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6151 that.
6152
6153 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6154 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6155 registers if they are not general registers.
6156
6157 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6158 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6159 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6160 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6161 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6162 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6163
6164 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6165 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6166 @end defmac
6167
6168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6169 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6170 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6171 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6172 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6173 that.
6174
6175 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6176 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6177 registers if they are not general registers.
6178
6179 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6180 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6181 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6182 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6183 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6184 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6185
6186 The default version of this function returns 2.
6187 @end deftypefn
6188
6189 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6190 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6191 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6192 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6193 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6194 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6195 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6196
6197 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6198 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6199 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6200 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6201 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6202 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6203
6204 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6205 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6206 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6207 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6208 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6209 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6210 are the same as to this macro.
6211
6212 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6213 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6214 @end defmac
6215
6216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6217 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6218 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6219 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6220 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6221 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6222 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6223
6224 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6225 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6226 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6227 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6228 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6229 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6230
6231 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6232 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6233 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6234 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6235 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6236 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6237 are the same as to this target hook.
6238 @end deftypefn
6239
6240 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6241 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6242 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6243 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6244 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6245 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6246 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6247 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6248 @end defmac
6249
6250 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6251 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6252 ordinarily expect.
6253
6254 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6255 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6256 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6257 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6258 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6259 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6260
6261 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6262 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6263 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6264 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6265 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6266 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6267 @end defmac
6268
6269 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6270 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6271 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6272 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6273 handler.
6274
6275 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6276 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6277 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6278 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6279 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6280
6281 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6282 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6283 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6284 @end defmac
6285
6286 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6287 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6288 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6289 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6290 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6291
6292 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6293 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6294 the number of such sequences.
6295
6296 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6297 optimized for speed rather than size.
6298
6299 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6300 @end defmac
6301
6302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6303 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6304 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6305 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6306 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6307 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6308 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6309 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6310
6311 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6312 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6313 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6314 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6315 units.
6316
6317 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6318 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6319 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6320 under consideration.
6321
6322 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6323 optimized for speed rather than size.
6324
6325 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6326 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6327 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6328 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6329 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6330 the body of the memory operation.
6331
6332 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6333 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6334 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6335 @end deftypefn
6336
6337 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6338 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6339 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6340 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6341 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6342 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6343 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6344 negative number from this hook.
6345 @end deftypefn
6346
6347 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6348 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6349 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6350 @end defmac
6351
6352 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6353 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6354 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6355 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6356 @end defmac
6357
6358 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6359 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6360 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6361 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6362 @end defmac
6363
6364 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6365 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6366 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6367 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6368 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6369
6370 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6371 optimized for speed rather than size.
6372
6373 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6374 @end defmac
6375
6376 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6377 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6378 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6379 a block set insn or a library call.
6380 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6381 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6382
6383 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6384 optimized for speed rather than size.
6385
6386 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6387 @end defmac
6388
6389 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6390 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6391 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6392 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6393 @end defmac
6394
6395 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6396 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6397 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6398 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6399 @end defmac
6400
6401 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6402 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6403 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6404 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6405 @end defmac
6406
6407 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6408 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6409 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6410 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6411 @end defmac
6412
6413 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6414 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6415 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6416 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6417 @end defmac
6418
6419 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6420 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6421 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6422 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6423 @end defmac
6424
6425 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6426 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6427 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6428 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6429 @end defmac
6430
6431 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6432 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6433 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6434 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6435 @end defmac
6436
6437 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6438 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6439 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6440 @end defmac
6441
6442 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6443 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6444 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6445 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6446 @end defmac
6447
6448 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6449 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6450 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6451 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6452 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6453 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6454
6455 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6456 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6457 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6458
6459 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6460 @end deftypefn
6461
6462 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6463 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6464
6465 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6466 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6467 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6468 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6469 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6470 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6471 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6472
6473 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6474 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6475
6476 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6477 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6478 instructions.
6479
6480 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6481 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6482 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6483 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6484 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6485
6486 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6487 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6488 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6489
6490 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6491 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6492 @end deftypefn
6493
6494 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6495 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6496 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6497 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6498
6499 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6500 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6501 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6502 all addresses will have equal costs.
6503
6504 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6505 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6506 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6507
6508 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6509 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6510 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6511 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6512 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6513 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6514 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6515 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6516
6517 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6518
6519 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6520 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6521 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6522 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6523 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6524 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6525 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6526 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6527 @end deftypefn
6528
6529 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6530 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6531 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6532 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6533 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6534 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6535 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6536 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6537 @end deftypefn
6538
6539 @node Scheduling
6540 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6541
6542 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6543 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6544 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6545 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6546
6547 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6548 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6549 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6550 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6551 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6552 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6553 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6554 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6555 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6556 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6557 @end deftypefn
6558
6559 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6560 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6561 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6562 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6563 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6564 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6565 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6566 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6567 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6568 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6569 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6570 was scheduled.
6571 @end deftypefn
6572
6573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6574 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6575 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6576 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6577 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6578 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6579 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6580 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6581 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6582 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6583 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6584 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6585 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6586 @end deftypefn
6587
6588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6589 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6590 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6591 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6592 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6593 scheduling priorities of insns.
6594 @end deftypefn
6595
6596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6597 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6598 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6599 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6600 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6601 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6602 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6603 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6604 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6605 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6606 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6607 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6608 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6609 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6610 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6611 @end deftypefn
6612
6613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6614 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6615 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6616 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6617 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6618 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6619 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6620 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6621 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6622 @end deftypefn
6623
6624 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6625 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6626 @end deftypefn
6627
6628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6629 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6630 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6631 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6632 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6633 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6634 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6635 @end deftypefn
6636
6637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6638 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6639 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6640 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6641 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6642 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6643 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6644 calculated.
6645 @end deftypefn
6646
6647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6648 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6649 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6650 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6651 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6652 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6653 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6654 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6655 @end deftypefn
6656
6657 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6658 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6659 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6660 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6661 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6662 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6663 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6664 @end deftypefn
6665
6666 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6667 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6668 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6669 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6670 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6671 @end deftypefn
6672
6673 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6674 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6675 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6676 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6677 @end deftypefn
6678
6679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6680 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6681 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6682 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6683 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6684 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6685 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6686 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6687 @end deftypefn
6688
6689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6690 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6691 @end deftypefn
6692
6693 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6694 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6695 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6696 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6697 @end deftypefn
6698
6699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6700 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6701 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6702 @end deftypefn
6703
6704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6705 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6706 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6707 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6708 state on a single insn is not enough.
6709 @end deftypefn
6710
6711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6712 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6713 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6714 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6715 state on a single insn is not enough.
6716 @end deftypefn
6717
6718 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6719 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6720 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6721 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6722 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6723 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6724 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6725 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6726 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6727 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6728 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6729
6730 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6731 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6732 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6733 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6734 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6735 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6736 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6737 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6738 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6739
6740 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6741 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6742 schedules to choose the best one.
6743
6744 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6745 @end deftypefn
6746
6747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
6748
6749 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6750 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6751 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6752 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6753 the current round of multipass scheduling.
6754 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6755 number of cycles.
6756 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6757 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6758 to allow backends make correct judgements.
6759
6760 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6761 @end deftypefn
6762
6763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6764 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6765 scheduling.
6766 @end deftypefn
6767
6768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6769 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6770 @end deftypefn
6771
6772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6773 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6774 an instruction.
6775 @end deftypefn
6776
6777 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6778 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6779 round of multipass scheduling.
6780 @end deftypefn
6781
6782 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6783 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6784 @end deftypefn
6785
6786 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6787 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6788 @end deftypefn
6789
6790 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6791 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6792 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6793 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6794 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6795 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6796 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6797 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6798 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6799 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6800 and the current processor cycle.
6801 @end deftypefn
6802
6803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6804 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6805 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6806 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6807 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6808 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6809 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6810 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6811 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6812 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6813 and @code{false} otherwise.
6814
6815 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6816 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6817 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6818 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6819 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6820 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6821 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6822 @end deftypefn
6823
6824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6825 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6826 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6827 per instruction data structures.
6828 @end deftypefn
6829
6830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6831 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6832 @end deftypefn
6833
6834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6835 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6836 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6837 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6838 @end deftypefn
6839
6840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6841 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6842 @end deftypefn
6843
6844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6845 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6846 @end deftypefn
6847
6848 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6849 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6850 @end deftypefn
6851
6852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6853 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6854 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6855 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6856 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6857 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6858 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6859 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6860 the generated speculative pattern.
6861 @end deftypefn
6862
6863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6864 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6865 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6866 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6867 @end deftypefn
6868
6869 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6870 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6871 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6872 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6873 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6874 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6875 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6876 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6877 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6878 @end deftypefn
6879
6880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6881 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6882 enabled/used.
6883 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6884 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6885 @end deftypefn
6886
6887 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6888 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6889 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6890 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6891 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6892 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6893 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6894 @end deftypefn
6895
6896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
6897 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6898 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6899 @end deftypefn
6900
6901 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
6902 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6903 in its second parameter.
6904 @end deftypefn
6905
6906 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6907 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6908 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6909 also the latencies of operations.
6910 @end deftypevr
6911
6912 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
6913 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6914 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6915 @end deftypefn
6916
6917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
6918 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
6919 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
6920 are returned via pointer parameters.
6921
6922 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
6923 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
6924 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
6925 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
6926 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
6927 should be calculated and returned.
6928
6929 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
6930 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
6931 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
6932 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
6933 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
6934 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
6935 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
6936 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
6937 instructions.
6938
6939 Given below example:
6940
6941 @smallexample
6942 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6943 add r4, r4, r10
6944 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6945 sub r5, r5, r15
6946 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6947 add r4, r4, r11
6948 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6949 sub r5, r5, r16
6950 @end smallexample
6951
6952 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
6953 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
6954 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
6955 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
6956 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
6957
6958 @smallexample
6959 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
6960 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6961 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
6962 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6963 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
6964 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6965 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
6966 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6967 @end smallexample
6968
6969 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
6970 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
6971 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
6972
6973 @smallexample
6974 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6975 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6976 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6977 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6978 add r4, r4, r10
6979 sub r5, r5, r15
6980 add r4, r4, r11
6981 sub r5, r5, r16
6982 @end smallexample
6983
6984 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
6985
6986 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
6987 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
6988
6989 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
6990 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
6991 @end deftypefn
6992
6993 @node Sections
6994 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6995 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6996 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6997
6998 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6999 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7000 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7001 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7002 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7003 of sections.
7004
7005 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7006 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7007 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7008 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7009 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7010 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7011 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7012
7013 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7014 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7015 to be string literals.
7016
7017 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7018 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7019 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7020 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7021
7022 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7023 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7024 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7025 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7026 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7027 reuse @code{text_section}.
7028
7029 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7030 if the target does not provide them.
7031
7032 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7033 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7034 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7035 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7036 @end defmac
7037
7038 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7039 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7040 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7041 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7042 @end defmac
7043
7044 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7045 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7046 executed functions in the program.
7047 @end defmac
7048
7049 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7050 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7051 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7052 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7053 @end defmac
7054
7055 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7056 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7057 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7058 initialized, writable small data.
7059 @end defmac
7060
7061 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7062 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7063 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7064 data.
7065 @end defmac
7066
7067 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7068 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7069 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7070 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7071 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7072 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7073 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7074 used.
7075 @end defmac
7076
7077 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7078 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7079 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7080 uninitialized, writable small data.
7081 @end defmac
7082
7083 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7084 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7085 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7086 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7087 @end defmac
7088
7089 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7090 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7091 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7092 default is @code{'T'}.
7093 @end defmac
7094
7095 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7096 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7097 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7098 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7099 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7100 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7101 @end defmac
7102
7103 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7104 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7105 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7106 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7107 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7108 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7109 @end defmac
7110
7111 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7112 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7113 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7114 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7115 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7116 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7117 @end defmac
7118
7119 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7120 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7121 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7122 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7123 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7124 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7125 @end defmac
7126
7127 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7128 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7129 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7130 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7131 @end defmac
7132
7133 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7134 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7135 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7136 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7137 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7138 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7139 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7140 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7141 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7142 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7143 @end defmac
7144
7145 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7146 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7147 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7148 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7149 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7150 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7151 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7152 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7153 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7154 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7155 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7156 @end defmac
7157
7158 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7159 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7160 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7161 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7162 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7163 @end defmac
7164
7165 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7166 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7167 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7168 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7169 readonly data section is used.
7170
7171 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7172 @end defmac
7173
7174 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7175 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7176 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7177 of its own that you need to create.
7178
7179 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7180 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7181 described below.
7182 @end deftypefn
7183
7184 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7185 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7186 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7187 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7188 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7189
7190 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7191 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7192 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7193 in read-only sections even in executables.
7194 @end deftypefn
7195
7196 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7197 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7198 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7199 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7200 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7201 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7202 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7203
7204 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7205 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7206
7207 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7208 @end deftypefn
7209
7210 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7211 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7212 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7213
7214 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7215 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7216 it is unlikely to be called.
7217 @end defmac
7218
7219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7220 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7221 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7222 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7223 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7224
7225 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7226 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7227 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7228 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7229 @end deftypefn
7230
7231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7232 Return the readonly data section associated with
7233 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7234 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7235 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7236 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7237 otherwise.
7238 @end deftypefn
7239
7240 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7241 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7242 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7243 the string if a different section name should be used.
7244 @end deftypevr
7245
7246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7247 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7248 @end deftypefn
7249
7250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7251 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7252 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7253 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7254 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7255 in bits.
7256
7257 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7258 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7259 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7260 @end deftypefn
7261
7262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7263 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7264 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7265 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7266 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7267 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7268 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7269 returns the @var{id} provided.
7270 @end deftypefn
7271
7272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7273 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7274 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7275 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7276
7277 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7278 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7279 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7280 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7281 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7282
7283 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7284 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7285 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7286 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7287 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7288 leave it alone.)
7289
7290 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7291 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7292 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7293 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7294 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7295 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7296
7297 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7298 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7299 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7300 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7301 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7302 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7303
7304 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7305 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7306 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7307 before overriding it.
7308 @end deftypefn
7309
7310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7311 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7312 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7313 may have added.
7314 @end deftypefn
7315
7316 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7317 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7318 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7319 @end deftypefn
7320
7321 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7322 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7323 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7324 @end deftypevr
7325
7326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7327 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7328
7329 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7330 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7331 @end deftypefn
7332
7333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7334 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7335 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7336 or executable image).
7337
7338 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7339 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7340 currently supported object file formats.
7341 @end deftypefn
7342
7343 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7344 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7345 The default value is false.
7346 @end deftypevr
7347
7348
7349 @node PIC
7350 @section Position Independent Code
7351 @cindex position independent code
7352 @cindex PIC
7353
7354 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7355 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7356 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7357 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7358 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7359 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7360 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7361 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7362 relative addresses.
7363 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7364 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7365
7366 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7367 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7368 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7369 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7370 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7371 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7372 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7373 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7374 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7375 @end defmac
7376
7377 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7378 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7379 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7380 the default is zero. Do not define
7381 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7382 @end defmac
7383
7384 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7385 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7386 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7387 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7388 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7389 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7390 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7391 position independent code.
7392 @end defmac
7393
7394 @node Assembler Format
7395 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7396
7397 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7398 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7399 instructions do.
7400
7401 @menu
7402 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7403 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7404 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7405 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7406 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7407 and termination routines.
7408 * Macros for Initialization::
7409 Specific macros that control the handling of
7410 initialization and termination routines.
7411 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7412 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7413 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7414 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7415 @end menu
7416
7417 @node File Framework
7418 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7419 @cindex assembler format
7420 @cindex output of assembler code
7421
7422 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7423 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7424
7425 @findex default_file_start
7426 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7427 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7428 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7429 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7430 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7431 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7432 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7433 @end deftypefn
7434
7435 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7436 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7437 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7438 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7439 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7440 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7441 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7442 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7443
7444 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7445 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7446 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7447 @end deftypevr
7448
7449 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7450 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7451 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7452 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7453 this to be done. The default is false.
7454 @end deftypevr
7455
7456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7457 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7458 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7459 @end deftypefn
7460
7461 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7462 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7463 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7464 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7465 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7466 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7467 this function.
7468 @end deftypefun
7469
7470 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7471 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7472 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7473 nothing.
7474 @end deftypefn
7475
7476 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7477 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7478 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7479 nothing.
7480 @end deftypefn
7481
7482 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7483 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7484 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7485 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7486 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7487 nothing.
7488 @end deftypefn
7489
7490 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7491 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7492 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7493 the end of the line.
7494 @end defmac
7495
7496 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7497 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7498 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7499 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7500 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7501 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7502 @end defmac
7503
7504 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7505 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7506 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7507 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7508 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7509 @end defmac
7510
7511 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7512 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7513 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7514 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7515
7516 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7517 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7518 @end defmac
7519
7520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7521 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7522
7523 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7524 @end deftypefn
7525
7526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7527 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7528 @end deftypefn
7529
7530 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7531 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7532 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7533 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7534 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7535 of the filename using this macro.
7536 @end defmac
7537
7538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7539 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7540 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7541 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7542 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7543 this section is associated.
7544 @end deftypefn
7545
7546 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7547 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7548 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7549 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7550 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7551 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7552 (from static destructors).
7553 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7554 @end deftypefn
7555
7556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7557 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7558 @end deftypefn
7559
7560 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7561 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7562 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7563 @end deftypevr
7564
7565 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7566 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7567 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7568 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7569 This is true on most ELF targets.
7570 @end deftypevr
7571
7572 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7573 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7574 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7575 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7576 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7577
7578 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7579 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7580 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7581 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7582 @end deftypefn
7583
7584 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7585 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7586 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7587 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7588 It can take the following values:
7589
7590 @table @gcctabopt
7591 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7592 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7593
7594 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7595 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7596 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7597 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7598 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7599 various different individual optimization passes.
7600
7601 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7602 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7603 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7604 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7605 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7606 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7607 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7608 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7609 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7610 switches.
7611
7612 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7613 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7614
7615 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7616 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7617 @end table
7618
7619 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7620 supported in the future.
7621
7622 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7623 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7624 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7625 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7626 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7627 hook.
7628 @end deftypefn
7629
7630 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7631 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7632 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7633 hook.
7634 @end deftypevr
7635
7636 @need 2000
7637 @node Data Output
7638 @subsection Output of Data
7639
7640
7641 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7642 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7643 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7644 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7645 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7646 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7647 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7648 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7649 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7650 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7651 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7652 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7653 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7654 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7655
7656 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7657 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7658 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7659 @end deftypevr
7660
7661 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7662 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7663 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7664 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7665 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7666 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7667 split the object into smaller parts.
7668
7669 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7670 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7671 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7672 @end deftypefn
7673
7674 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7675 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7676 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7677 @end deftypefn
7678
7679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7680 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7681 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7682 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7683 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7684
7685 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7686 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7687 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7688 return @code{true}.
7689 @end deftypefn
7690
7691 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7692 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7693 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7694 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7695 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7696
7697 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7698 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7699 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7700 @end defmac
7701
7702 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7703 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7704 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7705 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7706 @end defmac
7707
7708 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7709 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7710 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7711 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7712 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7713 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7714 pool before the function.
7715 @end defmac
7716
7717 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7718 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7719 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7720 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7721 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7722 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7723 immediately after this call.
7724
7725 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7726 not be defined.
7727 @end defmac
7728
7729 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7730 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7731 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7732 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7733
7734 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7735 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7736 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7737 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7738 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7739 alignment.
7740
7741 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7742 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7743 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7744 Here is how to do this:
7745
7746 @smallexample
7747 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7748 @end smallexample
7749
7750 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7751 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7752 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7753
7754 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7755 @end defmac
7756
7757 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7758 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7759 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7760 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7761 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7762 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7763
7764 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7765 define this macro.
7766 @end defmac
7767
7768 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7769 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7770 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7771 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7772 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7773
7774 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7775 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7776 @end defmac
7777
7778 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7779 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7780 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7781 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7782 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7783 @end deftypevr
7784
7785 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7786 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7787
7788 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7789 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7790 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7791 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7792 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7793 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7794 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7795 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7796 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7797 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7798 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7799 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7800 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7801 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7802 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7803 on the host machine.
7804
7805 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7806 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7807 machine's memory.
7808 @end defmac
7809
7810 @node Uninitialized Data
7811 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7812
7813 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7814 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7815
7816 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7817 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7818 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7819 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7820 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7821 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7822 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7823 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7824 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7825 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7826 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7827 an ordinary undefined external.
7828
7829 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7830 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7831 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7832
7833 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7834 common global variables are output.
7835 @end defmac
7836
7837 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7838 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7839 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7840 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7841 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7842 as the number of bits.
7843 @end defmac
7844
7845 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7846 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7847 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7848 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7849 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7850 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7851 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7852 @end defmac
7853
7854 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7855 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7856 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7857 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7858 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7859
7860 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7861 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7862 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7863 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7864 the name, and a newline.
7865
7866 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7867 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7868 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7869 You do not need to do both.
7870
7871 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7872 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7873 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7874 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7875 common in order to save space in the object file.
7876 @end defmac
7877
7878 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7879 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7880 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7881 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7882 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7883
7884 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7885 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7886 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7887
7888 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7889 static variables are output.
7890 @end defmac
7891
7892 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7893 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7894 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7895 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7896 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7897 as the number of bits.
7898 @end defmac
7899
7900 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7901 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7902 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7903 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7904 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7905 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7906 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7907 @end defmac
7908
7909 @node Label Output
7910 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7911
7912 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7913 This is about outputting labels.
7914
7915 @findex assemble_name
7916 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7917 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7918 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7919 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7920 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7921 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7922 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7923 @end defmac
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7928 a function.
7929 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7930 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7931 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7932 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7933
7934 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7935 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7936 @end defmac
7937
7938 @findex assemble_name_raw
7939 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7940 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7941 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7942 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7943 that it is more efficient.
7944 @end defmac
7945
7946 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7947 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7948 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7949 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7950 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7951
7952 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7953 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7954 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7955 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7956 define this macro.
7957 @end defmac
7958
7959 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7960 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7961 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7962 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7963 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7964 provided.
7965 @end defmac
7966
7967 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7968 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7969 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7970 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7971 address.
7972
7973 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7974 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7975 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7976 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7977 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7978 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7979 @end defmac
7980
7981 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7982 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7983 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7984 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7985 @samp{.} is used instead.
7986 @end defmac
7987
7988 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7989 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7990 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7991 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7992 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7993 @end defmac
7994
7995 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7996 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7997 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7998 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7999 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8000
8001 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8002 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8003 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8004 types at all, do not define this macro.
8005 @end defmac
8006
8007 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8008 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8009 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8010 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8011 the default is not to define this macro.
8012
8013 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8014 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8015 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8016 types at all, do not define this macro.
8017 @end defmac
8018
8019 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8020 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8021 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8022 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8023 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8024 you should not count on this.
8025
8026 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8027 definition of this macro is provided.
8028 @end defmac
8029
8030 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8031 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8032 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8033 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8034 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8035 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8036 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8037
8038 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8039 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8040
8041 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8042 of this macro.
8043 @end defmac
8044
8045 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8046 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8047 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8048 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8049 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8050 representing the function.
8051
8052 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8053
8054 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8055 of this macro.
8056 @end defmac
8057
8058 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8059 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8060 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8061 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8062 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8063 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8064 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8065
8066 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8067 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8068
8069 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8070 of this macro.
8071 @end defmac
8072
8073 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8074 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8075 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8076 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8077 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8078 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8079
8080 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8081
8082 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8083 of this macro.
8084 @end defmac
8085
8086 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8087 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8088 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8089 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8090 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8091 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8092
8093 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8094 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8095
8096 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8097 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8098 @end defmac
8099
8100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8101 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8102 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8103 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8104 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8105 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8106 will be an internal label.
8107
8108 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8109 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8110
8111 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8112 @end deftypefn
8113
8114 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8115 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8116 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8117 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8118
8119 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8120 nothing.
8121 @end defmac
8122
8123 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8124 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8125 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8126 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8127 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8128 something about the size of the object.
8129
8130 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8131 nothing.
8132
8133 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8134 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8135 @end defmac
8136
8137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8138 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8139 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8140 that is, available for reference from other files.
8141
8142 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8143 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8144 @end deftypefn
8145
8146 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8147 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8148 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8149 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8150
8151 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8152 @end deftypefn
8153
8154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8155 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8156 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8157 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8158 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8159 @end deftypefn
8160
8161 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8162 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8163 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8164 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8165 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8166 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8167 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8168 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8169
8170 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8171 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8172 macro.
8173 @end defmac
8174
8175 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8176 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8177 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8178 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8179 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8180 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8181 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8182 to make @var{name} weak.
8183 @end defmac
8184
8185 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8186 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8187 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8188 declaration of @code{name}.
8189 @end defmac
8190
8191 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8192 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8193 supports weak symbols.
8194
8195 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8196 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8197 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8198 @end defmac
8199
8200 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8201 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8202
8203 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8204 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8205 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8206 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8207 @end defmac
8208
8209 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8210 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8211 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8212 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8213 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8214 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8215 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8216 @end defmac
8217
8218 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8219 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8220 semantics.
8221
8222 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8223 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8224 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8225 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8226 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8227 be emitted as one-only.
8228 @end defmac
8229
8230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8231 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8232 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8233 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8234 @end deftypefn
8235
8236 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8237 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8238 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8239 The default is @code{0}.
8240
8241 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8242 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8243 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8244 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8245 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8246 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8247 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8248
8249 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8250 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8251 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8252 table of contents.
8253 @end defmac
8254
8255 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8256 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8257 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8258 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8259 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8260 declaration.
8261
8262 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8263 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8264 @end defmac
8265
8266 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8267 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8268 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8269 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8270 @end deftypefn
8271
8272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8273 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8274 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8275 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8276 @end deftypefn
8277
8278 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8279 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8280 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8281 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8282 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8283 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8284 @end defmac
8285
8286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8287 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8288 @end deftypefn
8289
8290 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8291 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8292 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8293 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8294 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8295 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8296 @end defmac
8297
8298 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8299 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8300 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8301 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8302 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8303 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8304 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8305 being taken.
8306 @end defmac
8307
8308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8309 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8310 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8311
8312 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8313 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8314 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8315
8316 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8317 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8318 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8319 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8320 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8321
8322 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8323 @end deftypefn
8324
8325 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8326 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8327 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8328 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8329 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8330 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8331 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8332 bundles.
8333
8334 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8335 used.
8336 @end defmac
8337
8338 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8339 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8340 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8341
8342 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8343 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8344 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8345
8346 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8347 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8348 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8349 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8350 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8351 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8352 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8353 @end defmac
8354
8355 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8356 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8357 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8358 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8359 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8360
8361 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8362 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8363 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8364 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8365 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8366 internal static variables in different scopes.
8367
8368 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8369 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8370 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8371 between the name and the number will suffice.
8372
8373 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8374 which is correct for most systems.
8375 @end defmac
8376
8377 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8378 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8379 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8380
8381 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8382 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8383 correct for most systems.
8384 @end defmac
8385
8386 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8387 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8388 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8389 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8390 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8391 the tree nodes are available.
8392
8393 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8394 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8395 correct for most systems.
8396 @end defmac
8397
8398 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8399 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8400 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8401 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8402 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8403 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8404 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8405 @end defmac
8406
8407 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8408 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8409 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8410 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8411 an undefined weak symbol.
8412
8413 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8414 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8415 @end defmac
8416
8417 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8418 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8419 Objective-C methods.
8420
8421 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8422 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8423 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8424 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8425
8426 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8427 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8428 systems define other ways of computing names.
8429
8430 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8431 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8432 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8433 50 characters extra.
8434
8435 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8436 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8437 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8438 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8439
8440 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8441 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8442 @end defmac
8443
8444 @node Initialization
8445 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8446 @cindex initialization routines
8447 @cindex termination routines
8448 @cindex constructors, output of
8449 @cindex destructors, output of
8450
8451 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8452 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8453 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8454 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8455 @code{main} is called.
8456
8457 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8458 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8459 terminates.
8460
8461 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8462 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8463 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8464 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8465
8466 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8467 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8468 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8469
8470 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8471 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8472 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8473 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8474 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8475
8476 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8477 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8478 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8479 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8480 pointer containing zero.
8481
8482 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8483 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8484 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8485 list; destructors in forward order.
8486
8487 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8488 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8489 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8490 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8491 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8492 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8493 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8494 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8495
8496 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8497 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8498 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8499 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8500 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8501
8502 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8503 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8504 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8505 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8506 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8507
8508 @smallexample
8509 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8510 @end smallexample
8511
8512 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8513 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8514 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8515 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8516 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8517
8518 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8519 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8520 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8521 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8522 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8523 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8524
8525 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8526 macro properly.
8527
8528 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8529 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8530 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8531 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8532 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8533 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8534
8535 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8536 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8537 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8538 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8539 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8540 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8541 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8542 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8543 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8544 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8545 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8546 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8547 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8548 the initialization process.
8549
8550 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8551 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8552 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8553 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8554 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8555 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8556 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8557 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8558 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8559 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8560 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8561
8562 @ifinfo
8563 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8564 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8565 @end ifinfo
8566
8567 @node Macros for Initialization
8568 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8569
8570 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8571 and termination functions:
8572
8573 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8574 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8575 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8576 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8577 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8578 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8579 run the initialization functions.
8580 @end defmac
8581
8582 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8583 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8584 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8585 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8586 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8587 @end defmac
8588
8589 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8590 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8591 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8592 @end defmac
8593
8594 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8595 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8596 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8597 @end defmac
8598
8599 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8600 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8601 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8602 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8603 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8604 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8605
8606 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8607 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8608 exception tables embedded in the code.
8609 @end defmac
8610
8611 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8612 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8613 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8614 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8615 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8616 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8617 @end defmac
8618
8619 @defmac INVOKE__main
8620 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8621 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8622 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8623 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8624 @end defmac
8625
8626 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8627 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8628 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8629 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8630 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8631 @end defmac
8632
8633 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8634 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8635 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8636 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8637 @end deftypevr
8638
8639 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8640 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8641 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8642
8643 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8644 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8645 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8646 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8647
8648 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8649 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8650 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8651 is not defined.
8652 @end deftypefn
8653
8654 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8655 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8656 functions rather than initialization functions.
8657 @end deftypefn
8658
8659 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8660 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8661
8662 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8663 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8664 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8665
8666 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8667 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8668
8669 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8670 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8671 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8672 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8673
8674 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8675 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8676 @end defmac
8677
8678 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8679 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8680 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8681 @command{nm}.
8682 @end defmac
8683
8684 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8685 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8686 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8687 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8688 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8689 produces.
8690 @end defmac
8691
8692 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8693 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8694 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8695 termination functions in shared libraries:
8696
8697 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8698 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8699 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8700 @end defmac
8701
8702 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8703 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8704 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8705 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8706 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8707 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8708 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8709 @end defmac
8710
8711 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8712 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8713 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8714 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8715 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8716 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8717 @end defmac
8718
8719 @node Instruction Output
8720 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8721
8722 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8723 This describes assembler instruction output.
8724
8725 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8726 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8727 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8728 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8729 @end defmac
8730
8731 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8732 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8733 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8734 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8735 to registers using alternate names.
8736 @end defmac
8737
8738 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8739 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8740 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8741 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8742 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8743 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8744 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8745 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8746
8747 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8748 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8749 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8750 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8751 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8752 @end defmac
8753
8754 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8755 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8756 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8757
8758 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8759 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8760 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8761 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8762 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8763 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8764 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8765 so that it will not be output twice.
8766
8767 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8768 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8769 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8770 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8771 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8772
8773 @findex recog_data.operand
8774 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8775 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8776
8777 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8778 in the usual way.
8779 @end defmac
8780
8781 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8782 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8783 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8784 they will be output differently.
8785
8786 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8787 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8788 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8789 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8790 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8791 by changing the contents of the vector.
8792
8793 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8794 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8795 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8796 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8797 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8798 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8799
8800 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8801 @end defmac
8802
8803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8804 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8805 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8806 if necessary.
8807
8808 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8809 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8810 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8811 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8812 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8813 by checking the contents of the vector.
8814 @end deftypefn
8815
8816 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8817 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8818 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8819 RTL expression.
8820
8821 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8822 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8823 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8824 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8825 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8826 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8827 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8828
8829 @findex reg_names
8830 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8831 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8832 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8833 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8834
8835 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8836 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8837 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8838 @var{code}.
8839 @end defmac
8840
8841 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8842 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8843 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8844 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8845 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8846 in this way.
8847 @end defmac
8848
8849 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8850 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8851 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8852 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8853
8854 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8855 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8856 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8857 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8858 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8859 Format}.
8860 @end defmac
8861
8862 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8863 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8864 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8865 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8866 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8867 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8868 or whatever.
8869
8870 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8871 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8872 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8873 @end defmac
8874
8875 @findex final_sequence
8876 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8877 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8878 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8879 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8880 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8881 being output.
8882
8883 @findex asm_fprintf
8884 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8885 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8886 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8887 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8888 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8889 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8890 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8891 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8892 files can define these macros differently.
8893 @end defmac
8894
8895 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8896 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8897 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8898 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8899 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8900 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8901 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8902 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8903 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8904 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8905 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8906 @end defmac
8907
8908 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8909 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8910 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8911 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8912 first variant.
8913
8914 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8915 @smallexample
8916 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8917 @end smallexample
8918 @noindent
8919 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8920 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8921 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8922 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8923 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8924 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8925 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8926 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8927 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
8928
8929 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8930 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8931 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8932
8933 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8934 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8935 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8936 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8937 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8938 opcodes or operand order.
8939 @end defmac
8940
8941 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8942 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8943 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8944 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8945 profiling.
8946 @end defmac
8947
8948 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8949 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8950 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8951 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8952 profiling.
8953 @end defmac
8954
8955 @node Dispatch Tables
8956 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8957
8958 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8959 This concerns dispatch tables.
8960
8961 @cindex dispatch table
8962 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8963 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8964 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8965 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8966 definitions of these labels are output using
8967 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8968 way here. For example,
8969
8970 @smallexample
8971 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8972 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8973 @end smallexample
8974
8975 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8976 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8977 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8978 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8979 mode and flags can be read.
8980 @end defmac
8981
8982 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8983 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8984 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8985
8986 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8987 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8988 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8989 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8990 For example,
8991
8992 @smallexample
8993 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8994 @end smallexample
8995 @end defmac
8996
8997 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8998 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8999 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9000 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9001 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9002 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9003
9004 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9005 for the table.
9006
9007 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9008 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9009 @end defmac
9010
9011 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9012 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9013 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9014 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9015 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9016 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9017 of the preceding label.
9018
9019 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9020 the jump-table.
9021 @end defmac
9022
9023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9024 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9025 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9026 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9027 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9028 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9029 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9030 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9031
9032 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9033 @end deftypefn
9034
9035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9036 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9037 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9038 to be broken up according to function.
9039
9040 The default is that no label is emitted.
9041 @end deftypefn
9042
9043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9044 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9045 @end deftypefn
9046
9047 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9048 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9049 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9050 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9051 @end deftypefn
9052
9053 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9054 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9055 @end deftypevr
9056
9057 @node Exception Region Output
9058 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9059
9060 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9061
9062 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9063 region.
9064
9065 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9066 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9067 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9068 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9069 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9070
9071 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9072 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9073 @end defmac
9074
9075 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9076 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9077 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9078 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9079
9080 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9081 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9082 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9083 be marked as not to be collected.
9084 @end defmac
9085
9086 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9087 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9088 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9089 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9090 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9091 @end defmac
9092
9093 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9094 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9095 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9096 @end defmac
9097
9098 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9099 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9100 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9101 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9102 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9103 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9104 @end defmac
9105
9106 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9107 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9108 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9109 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9110 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9111 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9112 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9113
9114 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9115 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9116 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9117
9118 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9119 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9120 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9121 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9122 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9123 depending on this setting.
9124
9125 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9126 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9127 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9128 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9129 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9130 @end deftypefn
9131
9132 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9133 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9134 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9135 command-line option processing.
9136 @end deftypevr
9137
9138 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9139 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9140 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9141 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9142 @end defmac
9143
9144 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9145 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9146 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9147 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9148 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9149 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9150 @end defmac
9151
9152 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9153 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9154 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9155 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9156 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9157 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9158 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9159 @end defmac
9160
9161 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9162 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9163 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9164 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9165 true otherwise.
9166 @end deftypevr
9167
9168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9169 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9170 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9171 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9172 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9173 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9174 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9175 @end deftypefn
9176
9177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9178 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9179 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9180 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9181 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9182 @end deftypefn
9183
9184 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9185 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9186 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9187 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9188 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9189 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9190 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9191 @end deftypefn
9192
9193 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9194 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9195 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9196 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9197 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9198 @end deftypefn
9199
9200 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9201 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9202 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9203 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9204 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9205 @end deftypevr
9206
9207 @node Alignment Output
9208 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9209
9210 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9211 This describes commands for alignment.
9212
9213 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9214 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9215 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9216
9217 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9218 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9219 define the macro.
9220
9221 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9222 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9223 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9224 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9225 @end defmac
9226
9227 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9228 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9229 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9230 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9231 @end deftypefn
9232
9233 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9234 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9235 a @code{BARRIER}.
9236
9237 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9238 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9239 define the macro.
9240 @end defmac
9241
9242 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9243 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9244 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9245 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9246 @end deftypefn
9247
9248 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9249 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9250 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9251
9252 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9253 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9254 define the macro.
9255
9256 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9257 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9258 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9259 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9260 @end defmac
9261
9262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9263 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9264 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9265 defined.
9266 @end deftypefn
9267
9268 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9269 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9270 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9271 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9272
9273 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9274 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9275 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9276 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9277 @end defmac
9278
9279 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9280 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9281 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9282 is defined.
9283 @end deftypefn
9284
9285 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9286 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9287 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9288 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9289 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9290 @end defmac
9291
9292 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9293 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9294 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9295 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9296 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9297 section.
9298 @end defmac
9299
9300 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9301 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9302 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9303 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9304 @end defmac
9305
9306 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9307 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9308 for padding, if necessary.
9309 @end defmac
9310
9311 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9312 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9313 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9314 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9315 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9316 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9317 @end defmac
9318
9319 @need 3000
9320 @node Debugging Info
9321 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9322
9323 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9324 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9325
9326 @menu
9327 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9328 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9329 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9330 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9331 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9332 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9333 @end menu
9334
9335 @node All Debuggers
9336 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9337
9338 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9339 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9340
9341 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9342 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9343 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9344 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9345 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9346 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9347 compiler and another for DBX@.
9348
9349 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9350 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9351 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9352 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9353 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9354
9355 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9356 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9357 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9358 @end defmac
9359
9360 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9361 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9362 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9363 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9364 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9365 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9366 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9367 @option{-g} options is used.
9368 @end defmac
9369
9370 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9371 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9372 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9373 @var{offset}.
9374 @end defmac
9375
9376 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9377 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9378 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9379 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9380 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9381 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9382 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9383
9384 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9385 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9386 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9387 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9388 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9389
9390 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9391 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9392 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9393 @end defmac
9394
9395 @node DBX Options
9396 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9397
9398 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9399 These are specific options for DBX output.
9400
9401 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9402 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9403 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9404 @end defmac
9405
9406 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9407 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9408 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9409 @end defmac
9410
9411 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9412 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9413 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9414 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9415 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9416 if there is any occasion to.
9417 @end defmac
9418
9419 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9420 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9421 in the text section.
9422 @end defmac
9423
9424 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9425 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9426 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9427 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9428 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9429 @end defmac
9430
9431 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9432 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9433 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9434 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9435 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9436 information format.
9437 @end defmac
9438
9439 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9440 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9441 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9442 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9443 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9444 @end defmac
9445
9446 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9447 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9448 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9449 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9450 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9451 @end defmac
9452
9453 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9454 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9455 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9456 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9457 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9458 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9459 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9460 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9461 @end defmac
9462
9463 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9464 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9465 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9466 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9467 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9468 if backslash is correct for your system.
9469 @end defmac
9470
9471 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9472 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9473 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9474 variable.
9475 @end defmac
9476
9477 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9478 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9479 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9480 @end defmac
9481
9482 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9483 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9484 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9485 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9486 @end defmac
9487
9488 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9489 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9490 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9491 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9492 @end defmac
9493
9494 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9495 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9496 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9497 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9498 @end defmac
9499
9500 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9501 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9502 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9503 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9504 code.
9505 @end defmac
9506
9507 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9508 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9509 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9510 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9511 an absolute address.
9512 @end defmac
9513
9514 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9515 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9516 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9517 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9518 @end defmac
9519
9520 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9521 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9522 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9523 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9524 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9525 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9526 number for a type number.
9527 @end defmac
9528
9529 @node DBX Hooks
9530 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9531
9532 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9533 These are hooks for DBX format.
9534
9535 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9536 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9537 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9538 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9539 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9540 unique labels in the assembly output.
9541
9542 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9543 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9544 @end defmac
9545
9546 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9547 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9548 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9549 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9550 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9551 @end defmac
9552
9553 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9554 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9555 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9556 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9557 @end defmac
9558
9559 @node File Names and DBX
9560 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9561
9562 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9563 This describes file names in DBX format.
9564
9565 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9566 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9567 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9568 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9569 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9570
9571 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9572 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9573
9574 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9575 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9576 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9577 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9578 @end defmac
9579
9580 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9581 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9582 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9583 the beginning of the file.
9584 @end defmac
9585
9586 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9587 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9588 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9589 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9590 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9591 @end defmac
9592
9593 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9594 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9595 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9596 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9597
9598 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9599 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9600 @end defmac
9601
9602 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9603 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9604 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9605 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9606 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9607 @end defmac
9608
9609 @need 2000
9610 @node SDB and DWARF
9611 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9612
9613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9614 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9615
9616 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9617 Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9618 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9619 @end defmac
9620
9621 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9622 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9623 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9624
9625 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9626 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9627 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9628 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9629 @end deftypefn
9630
9631 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9632 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9633 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9634 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9635 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9636 @end defmac
9637
9638 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9639 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9640 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9641 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9642 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9643 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9644 @end defmac
9645
9646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9647 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9648 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9649 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9650 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9651
9652 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9653 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9654
9655 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9656 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9657 @end deftypefn
9658
9659 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9660 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9661 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9662 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9663 @end defmac
9664
9665 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9666 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9667 @end deftypevr
9668
9669 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9670 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9671 @end deftypevr
9672
9673 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9674 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9675 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9676 @end deftypevr
9677
9678 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9679 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9680 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9681 @end deftypevr
9682
9683 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9684 True if register allocation and the passes
9685 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9686 targets.
9687 @end deftypevr
9688
9689 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9690 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9691 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9692 @end defmac
9693
9694 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9695 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9696 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9697 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9698 @end defmac
9699
9700 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9701 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9702 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9703 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9704 @end defmac
9705
9706 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9707 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9708 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9709 @end defmac
9710
9711 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9712 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9713 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9714 @end defmac
9715
9716 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9717 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9718 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9719 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9720 is referenced by a function.
9721 @end defmac
9722
9723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9724 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9725 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9726 @end deftypefn
9727
9728 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9729 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9730 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9731 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9732 not define them yourself.
9733 @end defmac
9734
9735 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9736 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9737 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9738 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9739 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9740 required.
9741 @end defmac
9742
9743 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9744 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9745 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9746 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9747 it.
9748 @end defmac
9749
9750 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9751 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9752 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9753 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9754 @end defmac
9755
9756 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9757 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9758 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9759 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9760 @end defmac
9761
9762 @need 2000
9763 @node VMS Debug
9764 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9765
9766 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9767 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9768
9769 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9770 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9771 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9772 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9773 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9774 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9775 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9776 @end defmac
9777
9778 @node Floating Point
9779 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9780 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9781 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9782
9783 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9784 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9785 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9786 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9787 doing the compilation.
9788
9789 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9790 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9791 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9792 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9793 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9794 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9795 target floating point formats are identical.
9796
9797 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9798 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9799 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9800 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9801
9802 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9803 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9804 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9805 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9806 quantity.
9807 @end defmac
9808
9809 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9810 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9811 @end deftypefn
9812
9813 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9814 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9815 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9816 @end deftypefn
9817
9818 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
9819 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9820 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9821 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9822 defined by the C language for both.
9823 @end deftypefn
9824
9825 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9826 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9827 @end deftypefn
9828
9829 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9830 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9831 @end deftypefn
9832
9833 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9834 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9835 @end deftypefn
9836
9837 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9838 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9839 @end deftypefn
9840
9841 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9842 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9843 @end deftypefn
9844
9845 @node Mode Switching
9846 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9847 @cindex mode switching
9848 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9849
9850 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9851 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9852 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9853
9854 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9855 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9856 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9857 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9858 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9859 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9860 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9861
9862 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9863 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9864 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9865 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9866 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9867 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9868 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
9869 are optional.
9870 @end defmac
9871
9872 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9873 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9874 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9875 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9876 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9877 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9878 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9879 entity in question.
9880 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9881 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9882 switch is needed / supplied.
9883 @end defmac
9884
9885 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
9886 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
9887 @end deftypefn
9888
9889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9890 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9891 @end deftypefn
9892
9893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9894 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
9895 @end deftypefn
9896
9897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
9898 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9899 @end deftypefn
9900
9901 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
9902 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9903 @end deftypefn
9904
9905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
9906 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9907 @end deftypefn
9908
9909 @node Target Attributes
9910 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9911 @cindex target attributes
9912 @cindex machine attributes
9913 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9914
9915 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9916 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9917 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9918
9919 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9920 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9921 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
9922 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9923 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9924 take.
9925 @end deftypevr
9926
9927 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9928 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9929 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9930 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9931 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9932 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9933 @end deftypefn
9934
9935 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9936 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9937 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9938 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9939 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9940 supposed always to be compatible.
9941 @end deftypefn
9942
9943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9944 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9945 the newly defined @var{type}.
9946 @end deftypefn
9947
9948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9949 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9950 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9951 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9952 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9953 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9954 merging.
9955 @end deftypefn
9956
9957 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9958 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9959 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9960 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9961 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9962 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9963 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9964 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9965
9966 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9967 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9968 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9969 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9970 will then define a function called
9971 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9972 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9973 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9974 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9975 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9976 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9977 @end deftypefn
9978
9979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9980 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9981 @end deftypefn
9982
9983 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9984 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9985 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9986 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9987 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9988 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9989 on this implementation detail.
9990 @end defmac
9991
9992 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9993 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9994 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9995 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9996 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9997 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9998 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9999 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10000 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10001 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10002 needed.
10003 @end deftypefn
10004
10005 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10006 @cindex inlining
10007 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10008 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10009 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10010 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10011 @end deftypefn
10012
10013 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10014 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10015 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10016 These function-specific options may differ
10017 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10018 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10019
10020 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10021 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10022 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10023 @end deftypefn
10024
10025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10026 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10027 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10028 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10029 @xref{Option file format}.
10030 @end deftypefn
10031
10032 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10033 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10034 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10035 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10036 @end deftypefn
10037
10038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10039 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10040 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10041 LTO bytecode.
10042 @end deftypefn
10043
10044 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10045 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10046 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10047 function-specific options.
10048 @end deftypefn
10049
10050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10051 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10052 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10053 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10054 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10055 @end deftypefn
10056
10057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10058 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10059 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10060 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10061 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10062
10063 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10064 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10065
10066 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10067 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10068 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10069 @end deftypefn
10070
10071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10072 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10073 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10074 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10075 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10076 different target machines.
10077 @end deftypefn
10078
10079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10080 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10081 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10082 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10083 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10084 @end deftypefn
10085
10086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10087 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10088 @end deftypefn
10089
10090 @node Emulated TLS
10091 @section Emulating TLS
10092 @cindex Emulated TLS
10093
10094 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10095 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10096 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10097 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10098 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10099 layer.
10100
10101 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10102 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10103 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10104 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10105
10106 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10107 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10108 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10109 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10110 @end deftypevr
10111
10112 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10113 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10114 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10115 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10116 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10117 registration function to be used.
10118 @end deftypevr
10119
10120 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10121 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10122 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10123 any section.
10124 @end deftypevr
10125
10126 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10127 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10128 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10129 section.
10130 @end deftypevr
10131
10132 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10133 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10134 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10135 @end deftypevr
10136
10137 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10138 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10139 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10140 @end deftypevr
10141
10142 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10143 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10144 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10145 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10146 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10147 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10148 @end deftypefn
10149
10150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10151 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10152 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10153 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10154 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10155 @end deftypefn
10156
10157 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10158 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10159 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10160 single objects. The default is false.
10161 @end deftypevr
10162
10163 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10164 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10165 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10166 @end deftypevr
10167
10168 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10169 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10170 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10171
10172 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10173 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10174 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10175 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10176
10177 @smallexample
10178 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10179 unsigned int d;
10180
10181 d = cp0count + 3;
10182 @end smallexample
10183
10184 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10185 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10186 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10187
10188 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10189 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10190 later in the function.
10191
10192 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10193 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10194 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10195
10196 @node PCH Target
10197 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10198 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10199
10200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10201 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10202 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10203 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10204 @end deftypefn
10205
10206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10207 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10208 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10209 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10210 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10211
10212 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10213 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10214 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10215 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10216
10217 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10218 suitable for most targets.
10219 @end deftypefn
10220
10221 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10222 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10223 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10224 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10225 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10226 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10227 @end deftypefn
10228
10229 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10230 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10231 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10232 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10233 to do anything here.
10234 @end deftypefn
10235
10236 @node C++ ABI
10237 @section C++ ABI parameters
10238 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10239
10240 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10241 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10242 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10243 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10244 @end deftypefn
10245
10246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10247 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10248 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10249 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10250 @end deftypefn
10251
10252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10253 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10254 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10255 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10256 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10257 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10258 @end deftypefn
10259
10260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10261 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10262 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10263 @end deftypefn
10264
10265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10266 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10267 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10268 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10269 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10270 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10271 backend's targeted operating system.
10272 @end deftypefn
10273
10274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10275 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10276 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10277 @code{false}.
10278 @end deftypefn
10279
10280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10281 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10282 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10283 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10284 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10285 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10286 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10287 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10288 @end deftypefn
10289
10290 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10291 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10292 @end deftypefn
10293
10294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10295 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10296 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10297 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10298 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10299 unit will not be COMDAT.
10300 @end deftypefn
10301
10302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10303 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10304 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10305 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10306 @end deftypefn
10307
10308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10309 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10310 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10311 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10312 @end deftypefn
10313
10314 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10315 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10316 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10317 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10318 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10319 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10320 @end deftypefn
10321
10322 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10323 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10324 @end deftypefn
10325
10326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10327 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10328 @end deftypefn
10329
10330 @node Named Address Spaces
10331 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10332 @cindex named address spaces
10333
10334 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10335 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10336 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10337 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10338 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10339 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10340 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10341 @code{const} type attributes.
10342
10343 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10344 pointers to the generic address space.
10345
10346 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10347 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10348 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10349 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10350 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10351 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10352 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10353 always 32 bits).
10354
10355 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10356 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10357 address space.
10358
10359 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10360 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10361 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10362 named address space #1:
10363 @smallexample
10364 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10365 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10366 @end smallexample
10367
10368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10369 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10370 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10371 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10372 @end deftypefn
10373
10374 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10375 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10376 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10377 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10378 @end deftypefn
10379
10380 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10381 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10382 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10383 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10384 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10385 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10386 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10387 target hooks for the given address space.
10388 @end deftypefn
10389
10390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10391 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10392 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10393 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10394 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10395 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10396 explicit named address space support.
10397 @end deftypefn
10398
10399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10400 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10401 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10402 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10403 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10404 @end deftypefn
10405
10406 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10407 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10408 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10409 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10410 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10411 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10412 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10413 @end deftypefn
10414
10415 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10416 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10417 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10418 @end deftypefn
10419
10420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10421 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10422 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10423 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10424 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10425 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10426 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10427 @end deftypefn
10428
10429 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10430 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10431 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10432 @end deftypefn
10433
10434 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10435 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10436 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10437 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10438 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10439 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10440 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10441 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10442 The default implementation does nothing.
10443 @end deftypefn
10444
10445 @node Misc
10446 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10447 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10448
10449 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10450 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10451
10452 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10453 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10454 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10455 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10456 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10457 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10458 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10459 @end defmac
10460
10461 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10462 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10463 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10464 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10465 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10466 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10467 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10468 @end defmac
10469
10470 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10471 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10472 elements of a jump-table should have.
10473 @end defmac
10474
10475 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10476 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10477 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10478 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10479 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10480 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10481 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10482 flags can be updated.
10483 @end defmac
10484
10485 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10486 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10487 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10488 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10489 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10490 is in effect.
10491 @end defmac
10492
10493 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10494 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10495 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10496 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10497 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10498 @end deftypefn
10499
10500 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10501 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10502 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10503 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10504 @end defmac
10505
10506 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10507 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10508 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10509 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10510 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10511 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10512 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10513 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10514
10515 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10516 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10517 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10518 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10519 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10520
10521 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10522 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10523 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10524 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10525 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10526
10527 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10528 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10529 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10530 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10531 @end defmac
10532
10533 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10534 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10535 extends.
10536 @end defmac
10537
10538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10539 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10540 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10541 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10542 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10543 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10544 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10545 @end deftypefn
10546
10547 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10548 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10549 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10550 @end defmac
10551
10552 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10553 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10554 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10555 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10556 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10557 at run-time.
10558 @end defmac
10559
10560 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10561 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10562 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10563 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10564 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10565 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10566 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10567 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10568 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10569 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10570 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10571
10572 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10573 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10574 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10575
10576 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10577 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10578 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10579 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10580 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10581
10582 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10583 @end defmac
10584
10585 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10587 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10588 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10589 @xref{shift patterns}.
10590
10591 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10592 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10593 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10594 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10595 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10596 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10597
10598 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10599 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10600 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10601
10602 The default implementation of this function returns
10603 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10604 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10605 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10606 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10607 by overriding it.
10608 @end deftypefn
10609
10610 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10611 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10612 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10613 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10614 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10615
10616 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10617
10618 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10619 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10620 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10621 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10622 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10623 such cases may improve things.
10624 @end defmac
10625
10626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10627 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10628 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10629 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10630 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10631 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10632 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10633 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10634 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10635 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10636 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10637
10638 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10639 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10640 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10641 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10642
10643 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10644 describe two related properties. If you define
10645 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10646 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10647 extension.
10648
10649 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10650 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10651 @code{mode}.
10652 @end deftypefn
10653
10654 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10655 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10656 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10657 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10658 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10659 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10660
10661 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10662 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10663 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10664 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10665 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10666 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10667 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10668 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10669 the compiler.
10670
10671 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10672 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10673 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10674 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10675 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10676 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10677 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10678 expression
10679
10680 @smallexample
10681 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10682 @end smallexample
10683
10684 @noindent
10685 can be converted to
10686
10687 @smallexample
10688 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10689 @end smallexample
10690
10691 @noindent
10692 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10693 tested into the sign bit.
10694
10695 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10696 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10697 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10698 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10699 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10700 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10701
10702 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10703 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10704 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10705 to be used:
10706
10707 @itemize @bullet
10708 @item
10709 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10710 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10711 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10712 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10713 combine the normalization with other operations.
10714
10715 @item
10716 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10717 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10718 other machines.
10719
10720 @item
10721 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10722 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10723 others.
10724
10725 @item
10726 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10727 @end itemize
10728
10729 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10730 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10731 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10732 those cases, e.g., one matching
10733
10734 @smallexample
10735 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10736 @end smallexample
10737
10738 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10739 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10740 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10741 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10742 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10743 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10744 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10745 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10746
10747 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10748 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10749 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10750 @end defmac
10751
10752 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10753 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10754 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10755 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10756 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10757 this macro.
10758 @end defmac
10759
10760 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10761 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10762 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10763 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10764 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10765 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10766 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10767 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10768 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10769 given mode.
10770 @end defmac
10771
10772 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10773 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10774 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10775 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10776 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10777 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10778 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10779 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10780 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10781 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10782 this value.
10783
10784 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10785 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10786
10787 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10788 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10789 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10790 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10791
10792 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10793 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10794 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10795 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10796 breaking the API@.
10797 @end defmac
10798
10799 @defmac Pmode
10800 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10801 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10802 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10803 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10804 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10805
10806 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10807 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10808 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10809 to @code{Pmode}.
10810 @end defmac
10811
10812 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10813 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10814 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10815 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10816 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10817 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10818 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10819 @end defmac
10820
10821 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10822 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10823 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10824 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10825 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10826 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10827
10828 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10829 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10830 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10831 @end defmac
10832
10833 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10834 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10835
10836 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10837 @end deftypefn
10838
10839 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10840 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10841 @end deftypefn
10842
10843 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10844 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10845 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10846 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10847 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10848 @end defmac
10849
10850 @findex #pragma
10851 @findex pragma
10852 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10853 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10854 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10855 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10856 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10857 setup required for the pragmas.
10858
10859 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10860 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10861 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10862
10863 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10864 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10865
10866 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10867 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10868 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10869 @end defmac
10870
10871 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10872 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10873
10874 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10875 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10876 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10877 pragma of the form
10878
10879 @smallexample
10880 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10881 @end smallexample
10882
10883 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10884 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10885 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10886 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10887 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10888 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10889 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10890 arguments of pragmas registered with
10891 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10892 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10893
10894 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10895 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10896 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10897 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10898 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10899 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10900 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10901 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10902 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10903 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10904 how to build this object file.
10905 @end deftypefun
10906
10907 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10908 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10909 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10910 @end defmac
10911
10912 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10913 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10914 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10915 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10916 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10917 @end defmac
10918
10919 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10920 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10921 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10922 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10923 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10924 @end defmac
10925
10926 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10927 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10928 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10929 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10930 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10931 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10932 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10933 you should define this macro.
10934
10935 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10936 @end defmac
10937
10938 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10939 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10940 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10941 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10942 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10943 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10944 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10945 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10946 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10947 slot of @var{insn}.
10948
10949 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10950 @end defmac
10951
10952 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10953 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10954 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10955 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10956 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10957 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10958
10959 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10960 @end defmac
10961
10962 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
10963 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
10964 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
10965 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
10966 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
10967
10968 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
10969 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
10970 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
10971 @end deftypefn
10972
10973 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10974 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10975 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10976 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10977 separate math library.
10978
10979 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10980 @end defmac
10981
10982 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10983 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10984 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10985
10986 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10987 is wrong.
10988 @end defmac
10989
10990 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10991 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10992 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10993 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10994 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10995 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10996 for cross-profiling.
10997 @end defmac
10998
10999 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11000
11001 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11002 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11003 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11004 1 if it does use cc0.
11005 @end defmac
11006
11007 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11008 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11009 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11010 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11011 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11012 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11013 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11014 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11015 @end defmac
11016
11017 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11018 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11019 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11020 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11021 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11022 @end defmac
11023
11024 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11025 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11026 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11027 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11028 about the currently processed blocks.
11029 @end defmac
11030
11031 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11032 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11033 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11034 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11035 to by @var{ce_info}.
11036 @end defmac
11037
11038 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11039 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11040 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11041 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11042 to by @var{ce_info}.
11043 @end defmac
11044
11045 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11046 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11047 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11048 to by @var{ce_info}.
11049 @end defmac
11050
11051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11052 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11053 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11054 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11055
11056 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11057 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11058 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11059 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11060
11061 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11062 definition is null.
11063 @end deftypefn
11064
11065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11066 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11067 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11068 necessary setup.
11069
11070 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11071 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11072 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11073 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11074
11075 To create a built-in function, call the function
11076 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11077 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11078 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11079 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11080 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11081 @end deftypefn
11082
11083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11084 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11085 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11086 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11087 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11088 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11089 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11090 @code{error_mark_node}.
11091 @end deftypefn
11092
11093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11094
11095 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11096 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11097 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11098 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11099 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11100 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11101 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11102 built-in function.
11103 @end deftypefn
11104
11105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11106 This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11107 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11108 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11109 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11110 obtained using this hook:
11111 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11112 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11113 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11114 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11115 @end deftypefn
11116
11117 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11118 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11119 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11120 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11121 @end deftypefn
11122
11123 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11124 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11125 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11126 address @var{loc}.
11127 @end deftypefn
11128
11129 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11130 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11131 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11132 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11133 @end deftypefn
11134
11135 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11136 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11137 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11138 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11139 @end deftypefn
11140
11141 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11142 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11143 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11144 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11145 @end deftypefn
11146
11147 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11148 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11149 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11150 @end deftypefn
11151
11152 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11153 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11154 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11155 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11156 @end deftypefn
11157
11158 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11159 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11160 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11161 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11162 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11163 (e.g. object has incomplete type).
11164 @end deftypefn
11165
11166 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11167 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11168 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11169 @end deftypefn
11170
11171 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11172 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11173 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11174 @end deftypefn
11175 @end deftypefn
11176 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11177 Return type to be used for bounds
11178 @end deftypefn
11179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11180 Return mode to be used for bounds.
11181 @end deftypefn
11182 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11183 Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11184 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11185 @end deftypefn
11186 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11187 Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11188 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11189 the number of generated statements.
11190 @end deftypefn
11191
11192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11193 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11194 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11195 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11196 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11197 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11198 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11199 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11200 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11201 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11202 @end deftypefn
11203
11204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11205 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11206 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11207 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11208 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11209 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11210 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11211 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11212 @end deftypefn
11213
11214 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11215 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11216 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11217 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11218 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11219 @end deftypefn
11220
11221 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11222 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11223 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11224 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11225 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11226 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11227 the two function decls that will be compared.
11228 @end deftypefn
11229
11230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11231 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11232 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11233 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11234 identical versions.
11235 @end deftypefn
11236
11237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11238 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11239 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11240 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11241 body must be generated.
11242 @end deftypefn
11243
11244 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11245 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11246 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11247 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11248 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11249 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11250 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11251 loop is only entered from the top.
11252
11253 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11254 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11255 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11256 @end deftypefn
11257
11258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11259
11260 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11261 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11262 could not be applied.
11263
11264 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11265 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11266 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11267 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11268 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11269 @end deftypefn
11270
11271 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11272 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11273 @end deftypefn
11274
11275 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11276 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11277 @end deftypefn
11278
11279 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11280 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11281 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11282 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11283 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11284 @end deftypefn
11285
11286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11287
11288 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11289 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11290 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11291 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11292 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11293 that had its initial value copied by using
11294 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11295 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11296 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11297 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11298 @code{MEM}.
11299 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11300 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11301 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11302 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11303 register in question will not be clobbered.
11304 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11305 allocation.
11306 @end deftypefn
11307
11308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11309 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11310 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11311 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11312 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11313 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11314 passed along.
11315 @end deftypefn
11316
11317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11318 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11319 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11320 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11321 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11322 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11323 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11324 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11325 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11326 The default hook function does nothing.
11327
11328 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11329 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11330 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11331 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11332 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11333 outside of any function scope.
11334 @end deftypefn
11335
11336 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11337 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11338 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11339 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11340 @end defmac
11341
11342 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11343 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11344 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11345 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11346 executable files.
11347 @end defmac
11348
11349 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11350 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11351 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11352 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11353 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11354 lists.
11355 @end defmac
11356
11357 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11358 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11359 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11360 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11361 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11362 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11363 defined as this expression:
11364
11365 @smallexample
11366 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11367 build_tree_list
11368 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11369 NULL))
11370 @end smallexample
11371 @end defmac
11372
11373 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11374 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11375 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11376 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11377 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11378
11379 @smallexample
11380 static bool
11381 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11382 @{
11383 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11384 @}
11385 @end smallexample
11386 @end deftypefn
11387
11388 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11389 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11390 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11391 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11392 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11393 to inter-block scheduling.
11394 @end deftypefn
11395
11396 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11397 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11398 registers
11399 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11400 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11401 that all target registers in the class returned by
11402 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11403 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11404 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11405 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11406 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11407 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11408 @end deftypefn
11409
11410 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11411 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11412 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11413 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11414 @end deftypefn
11415
11416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11417 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11418 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11419 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11420 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11421 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11422 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11423 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11424 @end deftypefn
11425
11426 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11427 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11428 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11429 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11430 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11431 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11432 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11433 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11434 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11435 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11436 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11437 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11438 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11439 @end deftypefn
11440
11441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11442 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11443 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11444 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11445 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11446 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11447 number of memory accesses.
11448 @end deftypefn
11449
11450 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11451 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11452 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11453 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11454 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11455 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11456 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11457 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11458 @end defmac
11459
11460 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11461 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11462 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11463 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11464 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11465 @end deftypefn
11466
11467 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11468 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11469 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11470 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11471 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11472 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11473 @end deftypefn
11474
11475 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11476 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11477 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11478 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11479 that are different from @option{-I}.
11480 @end deftypefn
11481
11482 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11483 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11484 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11485 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11486 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11487 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11488 @end defmac
11489
11490 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11491 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11492 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11493 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11494 @end defmac
11495
11496 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11497 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11498 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11499 @end defmac
11500
11501 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11502 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11503 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11504 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11505 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11506 @end defmac
11507
11508 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11509 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11510 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11511 @end defmac
11512
11513 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11514 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11515 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11516 and scanf formatter settings.
11517 @end defmac
11518
11519 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11520 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11521 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11522 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11523 @end deftypefn
11524
11525 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11526 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11527 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11528 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11529 @end deftypefn
11530
11531 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11532 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11533 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11534 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11535 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11536 @end deftypefn
11537
11538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11539 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11540 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11541 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11542 the front end.
11543 @end deftypefn
11544
11545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11546 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11547 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11548 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11549 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11550 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11551 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11552 @end deftypefn
11553
11554 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11555 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11556 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11557 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11558 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11559 conversion rules.
11560 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11561 @end deftypefn
11562
11563 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11564 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11565 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11566 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11567 @end defmac
11568
11569 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11570 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11571 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11572 @end defmac
11573
11574 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11575 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11576 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11577 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11578 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11579 @end defmac
11580
11581 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11582 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11583 necessary.
11584 @end deftypefn
11585
11586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11587 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11588 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11589 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11590 is needed.
11591 @end deftypefn
11592
11593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11594 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11595 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11596 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11597 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11598 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11599 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11600 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11601 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11602 @end deftypefn
11603
11604 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11605 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11606 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11607 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11608 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11609 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11610 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11611 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11612 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11613 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11614 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11615 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11616 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11617 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11618 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11619 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11620 @end deftypevr
11621
11622 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11623 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11624 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11625 supported by the target.
11626 @end deftypefn
11627
11628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11629 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11630 memory model bits are allowed.
11631 @end deftypefn
11632
11633 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11634 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11635 @end deftypevr
11636
11637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11638 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11639 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11640 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11641 @end deftypefn
11642
11643 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11644 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11645 @end deftypefn
11646
11647 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11648 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11649 @end deftypefn
11650
11651 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11652 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11653 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11654 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11655 @end deftypefn
11656
11657 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11658 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11659 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11660 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11661 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11662 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11663
11664 @end deftypefn
11665
11666 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11667
11668 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11669 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11670 to indicate that large integers are stored in
11671 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11672 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11673 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11674 representation.
11675
11676 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11677 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11678 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11679 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11680 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11681
11682 @itemize @bullet
11683 @item
11684 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11685 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11686 language since there are a variable number of elements.
11687
11688 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11689 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11690 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11691 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11692 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11693 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11694 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11695 not really a large change.
11696
11697 @item
11698 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11699 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11700 port in this code.
11701
11702 @item
11703 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11704 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11705 @end itemize
11706
11707 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11708 maintainer is familiar with.
11709
11710 @end defmac
This page took 0.494685 seconds and 6 git commands to generate.